This is only a preview of the March 2008 issue of Silicon Chip. You can view 32 of the 104 pages in the full issue, including the advertisments. For full access, purchase the issue for $10.00 or subscribe for access to the latest issues. Articles in this series:
Items relevant to "12V-24V High-Current DC Motor Speed Controller, Pt.1":
Articles in this series:
Items relevant to "A Digital VFO with LCD Graphics Display":
Items relevant to "A Low-Cost PC-to-I²C Interface For Debugging":
Items relevant to "One-Pulse-Per Second Driver For Quartz Clocks":
Purchase a printed copy of this issue for $10.00. |
SILICON
CHIP
MARCH 2008
PRINT POST APPROVED
- PP255003/01272
8
$ 50* NZ $ 9 90
SPEED CONTROLLER WITH
GRUNT!
Sp
ee
d,
24V
to
o!
40A
HOW TO SOLDER
AND WORK WITH
SMDs
INC GST
FREE
with this issue:
2008 DSE
CATALOG
(Aust
only)
One for the Amateurs:
DDS
HD DIGITAL TV VFO
ANALOG TV ENDS SOON!
INC GST
All you need to know about
siliconchip.com.au
March 2008 1
SILICON
CHIP
If you are seeing a blank page here, it is
more than likely that it contained advertising
which is now out of date and the advertiser
has requested that the page be removed to
prevent misunderstandings.
Please feel free to visit the advertiser’s website:
www.jaycar.com.au
Contents
Vol.21, No.3; March 2008
SILICON
CHIP
www.siliconchip.com.au
Features
9 How To Get Into Digital TV
Analog TV transmissions are on the way out. Here’s a look at what you’ll need
to receive all the new digital transmissions on an analog TV – by Alan Hughes
How To Get Into Digital
TV – Pages 9 & 14.
14 Review: Tevion TEV8200 HD Set-Top Box
Got an analog TV set? You need an HD Set Top Box! – by Leo Simpson
22 How To Solder Surface Mount Devices
Here’s how to solder SMD parts using simple tools – by Jim Rowe
46 PICAXE VSM: It’s Time to Play; Pt.3
Using some of the ‘virtual instrumentation’ included with the software, from a
simple voltmeter to an advanced I 2C protocol debugger – by Clive Seager
72 The I2C Bus: A Quick Primer
Mystified by the I 2C bus communications protocol? Read this – by Jim Rowe
82 Electric Flight
Battery-powered aircraft creates aviation history – by Ross Tester
Pro jects To Build
30 12V-24V High-Current DC Motor Speed Controller, Pt.1
It’s rated at up to 40A continuous, features automatic soft start & has good
speed regulation under load – by Mauro Grassi
12V-24V High-Current DC Motor
Speed Controller – Page 30.
58 A Digital VFO with LCD Graphics Display
This digital VFO uses a recycled Nokia cellular phone LCD to display analog
and digital frequency readouts – by Andrew Woodfield, ZL2PD
78 A Low-Cost PC-to-I2C Interface For Debugging
Tracking down bugs in I 2C circuits can be tricky. This PC interface lets you take
advantage of the free Philips/NXP “URD” debugging program – by Jim Rowe
91 One-Pulse-Per Second Driver For Quartz Clocks
Convert a low-cost quartz clock to GPS accuracy – by Jim Rowe
Special Columns
40 Serviceman’s Log
Foxing out a Foxtel installation – by the TV Serviceman
67 Circuit Notebook
(1) TV Field-Strength Meter; (2) Alternator Controller For Charging Deep Cycle
Batteries; (3) Emergency Light Uses 3W White LED; (4) PICAXE Light Box
Countdown Timer; (5) Impedance Bridge Measures At Three Frequencies;
(6) Simple Mosfet Tester; (7) PC Cooling-Fan Driver
Digital VFO With LCD
Readout – Page 58.
84 Vintage Radio
The batteries used to power vintage radios – by Rodney Champness
Departments
2 Publisher’s Letter
4 Mailbag
57 Order Form
siliconchip.com.au
96 Ask Silicon Chip
99 Notes & Errata
102 Market Centre
PC-to-I 2C Interface
For Debugging – Page 78.
March 2008 1
SILICON
CHIP
www.siliconchip.com.au
Publisher & Editor-in-Chief
Leo Simpson, B.Bus., FAICD
Production Manager
Greg Swain, B.Sc.(Hons.)
Technical Staff
John Clarke, B.E.(Elec.)
Ross Tester
Jim Rowe, B.A., B.Sc, VK2ZLO
Mauro Grassi, B.Sc.(Hons.)
Photography
Ross Tester
Reader Services
Ann Morris
Advertising Enquiries
Glyn Smith
Phone (02) 9939 3295
Mobile 0431 792 293
glyn<at>siliconchip.com.au
Regular Contributors
Brendan Akhurst
Rodney Champness, VK3UG
Mike Sheriff, B.Sc, VK2YFK
Stan Swan
SILICON CHIP is published 12 times
a year by Silicon Chip Publications
Pty Ltd. ACN 003 205 490. ABN 49
003 205 490 All material copyright
©. No part of this publication may
be reproduced without the written
consent of the publisher.
Printing: Hannanprint, Noble Park,
Victoria.
Distribution: Network Distribution
Company.
Subscription rates: $89.50 per year
in Australia. For overseas rates, see
the subscription page in this issue.
Editorial office:
Unit 1, 234 Harbord Rd,
Brookvale, NSW 2100.
Postal address: PO Box 139,
Collaroy Beach, NSW 2097.
Phone (02) 9939 3295.
Fax (02) 9939 2648.
E-mail: silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
Publisher’s Letter
High-definition TV in limbo
until the Olympics
This month, we highlight the end of analog television broadcasting (planned for December 2009) and
outline what you can do to pick up the High-Definition
TV broadcasts that are now available. In brief, if you
want to keep watching “free-to-air” TV, you have three
options. The first and most expensive is to purchase
an HD TV, either LCD or plasma display. The second is
to buy an HD personal video recorder (PVR) and hook
that up to your analog TV set and third, the cheapest option, is to purchase an
HD set top box (STB) and hook that up to your analog TV.
We would recommend one of the latter two options to most people because
they will save a lot of money. Most people have two or more quite useable analog
TV sets in their home and they should be capable of giving many more years
of service. So there is no hurry to go and buy the latest HDTV. Remember that
whatever HDTV set you buy now will be much cheaper in a year or two and
that is particularly important to the majority of people who make most of these
purchases on credit and then take years to pay them off. Better to save your dollars now and then buy a bigger and better HDTV set for cash in a few years’ time.
People may wonder why they should buy a high-definition PVR or STB when
they only have an analog set with a picture quality that is well below the state
of the art. Why not just wait until the end of analog broadcasting and then get a
PVR, STB or whatever? There are several reasons. The first is that the networks
are now broadcasting some programs only in HD format and a standard definition STB will not pick them up. Second, an HD STB will provide a composite
video output to allow an old analog TV to show the program, even though the
picture quality will no better than if you watched a DVD through the same set.
In spite of the above, it has to be said that the current selection of HDTV programs is very limited and generally not worth watching. Most of the time, the
programs on the HDTV channels are identical to the standard definition (SD)
programs on the same networks. The only networks that bother to put out useful
programs are the ABC and SBS. (By the way, all those people who reckon that
they cannot pick up SBS will have no problems when they go over to digital
reception – see next month’s issue).
Many documentaries on SBS and ABC are magnificent on the big screen and
they are even better in HDTV, with far more visual impact than on a small screen.
As far as commercial network programming is concerned, the quality of all
digital programs, whether standard definition or high definition is generally
woeful, unless you are interested in sport. Even then, while the video might
be good, especially on a really big screen or projector, some of the commentary
can be utterly banal. In fact, in my own home, the comment which applies to
most commercial network programming is that it probably causes brain damage!
In truth, while some programs are very good, most digital TV air space is wasted
and probably will remain so until the Beijing Olympics in August this year.
Leo Simpson
ISSN 1030-2662
* Recommended and maximum price only.
2 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
USB Mixed Signal Oscilloscope
Analog + Digital
Inventing the future requires a lot of test gear...
...or a BitScope
Digital Storage Oscilloscope
9
Dual Channel Digital Scope with industry
standard probes or POD connected analog
inputs. Fully opto-isolated.
Mixed Signal Oscilloscope
9
Capture and display analog and logic signals
together with sophisticated cross-triggers for
precise analog/logic timing.
Multi-Band Spectrum Analyzer
9
Display analog waveforms and their spectra
simultaneously. Base-band or RF displays with
variable bandwidth control.
Multi-Channel Logic Analyzer
9
Eight logic/trigger channels with event capture
to 25nS.
9
Built-in flash programmable DSP based function
generator. Operates concurrently with waveform
and logic capture.
DSP Waveform Generator
BS100U Mixed Signal Storage Scope & Analyzer
Innovations in modern electronics engineering are leading the new wave of
inventions that promise clean and energy efficient technologies that will
change the way we live.
Mixed Signal Data Recorder
It's a sophisticated world mixing digital logic, complex analog signals and
high speed events. To make sense of it all you need to see exactly what's
going on in real-time.
User Programmable Tools and Drivers
BS100U combines analog and digital capture and analysis in one cost
effective test and measurement package to give you the tools you need to
navigate this exciting new frontier.
9
Record to disk anything BitScope can capture.
Supports on-screen waveform replay and export.
9
Use supplied drivers and interfaces to build
custom test and measurement and data
acquisition solutions.
Standard 1M/20pF BNC inputs
Smart POD Connector
Opto-isolated USB 2.0
12VDC with low power modes
BitScope DSO Software for Windows and Linux
BS100U includes BitScope DSO the fast and
intuitive multichannel test and measurement
software for your PC or notebook.
Capture deep buffer one-shots, display waveforms
and spectra real-time or capture mixed signal data
to disk. Comprehensive integration means you can
view analog and logic signals in many different
ways all at the click of a button.
The software may also be used stand-alone to
share data with colleagues, students or customers.
Waveforms may be exported as portable image
files or live captures replayed on another PC as if a
BS100U was locally connected.
BitScope Designs
Ph: (02) 9436 2955
Fax: (02) 9436 3764
www.bitscope.com
MAILBAG
Letters and emails should contain complete name, address and daytime phone number. Letters to
the Editor are submitted on the condition that Silicon Chip Publications Pty Ltd may edit and has the
right to reproduce in electronic form and communicate these letters. This also applies to submissions
to “Ask SILICON CHIP” and “Circuit Notebook”.
Bigger battery for Prius
not viable
That bigger battery in the Prius
(SILICON CHIP, February 2008) did
not increase its “carbon economy”. It
just transferred the emissions from the
car’s tailpipe to the power plant’s. And
it has increased the mass of batteries
that have to be replaced periodically,
making the car’s lifetime carbon footprint worse.
It has been suggested seriously, with
numbers to prove it, that because of the
limited life of the batteries, a hybrid
like the Prius isn’t any greener over its
lifetime than the same car powered by
a turbo diesel.
Gordon Drennan,
Burton, SA.
Keep those microcontroller
projects coming
I have been a reader of SILICON
CHIP from day one. You are without
a doubt a world-class publication,
both by presentation and by quality
of projects. Just as a whole generation
of technical people enjoy the warm
glow of valves, another generation cut
Versatile 4-channel
mixer fix
After building the Versatile
4-Channel Mixer project (SILICON
CHIP, June 2007) and not being
able to get it working, I noticed in
the “Notes and Errata” section of a
recent issue that the published PC
board design was incorrect in the region of CON1-CON4. The suggested
fix was to reverse the metal contacts
of these sockets.
This was no easy task as these
sockets are obviously not meant to be
taken apart! The stubborn little beggars bluntly refused to come out of
the plastic mounting. However, two
days and sore fingers and thumbs
later, I managed to complete the task
4 Silicon Chip
their teeth on combinational logic. In
your wisdom you have moved with
the times and have introduced microcontroller projects. I believe you have
built a lifeline for your publication by
doing this.
By virtue of the kind of knowledge
you share in your projects I for one
have found a very satisfying career as
a PIC programmer. I started out by attempting projects in SILICON CHIP and
Elektor magazine, undertook some
more advanced study, including learning to program in ‘C’, and then went
in search of a job that allowed me to
apply these skills.
My point is that it all started from being able to access the basic knowledge
in a structured and non-threatening
way through SILICON CHIP. For the sake
of the future, please keep pushing microcontroller technology or what ever
replaces it in your publication. You
have shown the tenacity to survive
in a very difficult market by having
content and presentation that appeals
to many. Long may it continue.
Mark Weir,
Tauranga, NZ.
and install them on the board. My
perseverance paid off, as the mixer
is now working perfectly.
A couple of tips for people who
also purchased the early version of
the kit: I bought four completely new
sockets and swapped the contacts
over on them rather than attempting
to alter the desoldered ones.
Secondly, two of the new ones had
the number “3” on the under surface,
while the other two had the number
“4” on the bottom. Although they
were identical, for some unknown
reason the ones with number “4” on
them were much more co-operative
than those with the number “3”.
George Green,
Wollongong, NSW.
Ultrasonic
leak tester
On page 97 of the November 2007
issue, your correspondent is asking
about an ultrasonic device to detect
air leaks on vehicles with air brakes.
While such a device would probably
have advantages, I have found that a
very effective method for detecting air
leaks on truck air brakes is to “paint
on” soapy water, using a small paint
brush to suspect areas (pipe joiners
and connections etc).
Even when you can hear air leaks
they can still be difficult to pinpoint
but soapy water makes the job easier.
Peter Bell,
Glenorchy, Tas.
What is MPG?
Upon seeing the front cover of your
latest issue (February 2008), I couldn’t
believe what I was seeing! Miles? Gallons? Who in Australia still uses the
“old-fashioned” Imperial units? We
don’t! And how long has Australia
been metric? One thing I do remember
is that when I was going to tech some
thirty years ago, we students would
lose marks if our drawings did not
use “metric”.
I showed your magazine to my (elderly) mother who still does not fully
understand decimal currency! She
was as shocked as I was when she saw
the references to miles and gallons. If
you continue to publish magazines
with “old-fashioned” measurements
on the front cover, you will lose me,
as a reader, forever!
T. Robinson,
Woodend, Vic.
Imperial units no longer
used in Australia
I have browsed the February 2008
issue and am amazed that SILICON CHIP
would use units that are no longer
applicable in Australia. Australian vehicles have metric speedometers. Fuel
is purchased by the litre (or multiples
siliconchip.com.au
Serviceman should
stop blaming himself
I always read the “Serviceman’s
Log” with much interest, as I can
relate to many of the headaches
he has to endure. In particular,
the column in the December 2007
issue of SILICON CHIP piqued my
interest, since I can comment firsthand on the mystery of diode D10,
as follows.
The TinySwitch series of ICs are
designed for off-line flyback power
supplies. The flyback topology, al
though relatively inexpensive, suffers from very high voltage stresses
on the main power switch. The
stresses are not only the rectified
and reflected voltages but also any
additional voltage spikes caused by
the transformer’s leakage inductance. If unchecked, these spikes
will destroy the 700V Mosfet located
inside the IC.
To tame the voltage, an RCD
(resistor-capacitor-diode) snubber is
employed, as described in the IC’s
datasheets and application notes.
Unfortunately, OEMs are always
badgering power supply manufacturers to reduce costs. One of the
ways to shave a few pennies off is to
thereof) and distance is measured in
kilometres (the base unit being the
metre). L/100km appears to be the
standard unit for fuel economy.
I do realise there is something magical about the figure “100”.
Ray Smith,
Hoppers Crossing, NSW.
Comment: you are the second to comment on the 100mpg headline but as
you can see from the article, the Prius
readout is in mpg and in any case,
100mpg sounds far more impressive
than 2.825/100km (the actual equivalent to 100mpg). In fact, in the past we
have had readers comment that such
figures are meaningless to them.
Hydrogen for solar power
Why do all the comparisons of “direct” solar energy vs coal/hydroelectric conclude that solar is not suitable
for base load power? As a direct to
grid power source, this is true enough.
However, using solar power to electrolyse water to gain hydrogen which can
siliconchip.com.au
replace such an RCD snubber with a
TranZorb, a surge protector based on
a discrete avalanche diode.
Although this works and appears
to be a reliable solution, the truth
is that these diodes were never designed for repetitive avalanche duty
and thus create junction hotspots.
The diode may start leaking, causing the symptoms described, until it
eventually fails completely.
I know this first-hand since the
company I used to work for (a power
supply manufacturer) got hit with
a couple of product recalls for the
same reason. The problem was that
Power Integrations (the IC vendor)
had actually suggested this very
approach in their older application
notes, now revised with the RCD
clamp.
So please tell the poor Serviceman to stop blaming himself. It
was not his fault but rather a poor
design solution. If he can make the
supply work with the RCD clamp,
then leave it that way. Be sure to
properly insulate all the exposed
leads, as some pretty high voltages
will be present.
Fernando Garcia,
Brownsville, Texas, USA.
then be ‘burnt’ directly in a gas turbine
is already a proven technology. The
efficiency of the solar panels is not
really an issue; more panels would
make up the difference.
With all the land that is salt-affected
and becoming useless for anything
but sunlight collection, this could be
an income stream for those farmers
so affected. And if the panels were
made to let through the light frequencies they cannot convert to electron
release, would the land underneath
the panels still be usable for grazing/
crop production?
That is assuming that the alternative
method of producing hydrogen using
ceramic/direct hydrogen conversion
proves not to be more efficient. See
http://www.unsw.edu.au/news/pad/
articles/2004/aug/Solar_hydrogen.
html
Hydrogen could also be stored,
piped and used for power generation
inside the metropolitan areas as easily
as natural gas is today. The benefits
Atmel’s AVR, from
JED in Australia
JED has designed a range of
single board computers and
modules as a way of using the
AVR without SMT board design
The AVR570 module (above) is a way of
using an ATmega128 CPU on a user base
board without having to lay out the intricate,
surface-mounted surrounds of the CPU, and
then having to manufacture your board on
an SMT robot line. Instead you simply layout
a square for four 0.1” spaced socket strips
and plug in our pre-tested module. The
module has the crystal, resetter, AVR-ISP
programming header (and an optional JTAG
ICE pad), as well as programming signal
switching. For a little extra, we load a DS1305
RTC, crystal and Li battery underneath,
which uses SPI and port G.
See JED’s www site for a datasheet.
AVR573 Single Board Computer
This board uses the AVR570 module and
adds 20 An./Dig. inputs, 12 FET outputs, LCD/
Kbd, 2xRS232, 1xRS485, 1-Wire, power reg.
etc. See www.jedmicro.com.au/avr.htm
$330 PC-PROM Programmer
This programmer plugs into a PC printer
port and reads, writes and edits any 28 or
32-pin PROM. Comes with plug-pack, cable
and software.
Also available is a multi-PROM UV eraser
with timer, and a 32/32 PLCC converter.
JED Microprocessors Pty Ltd
173 Boronia Rd, Boronia, Victoria, 3155
Ph. 03 9762 3588, Fax 03 9762 5499
www.jedmicro.com.au
March 2008 5
JOIN THE TECHNOLOGY
AGE NOW
Mailbag: continued
with
PICAXE
Developed as a teaching tool,
the PICAXE is a low-cost “brain”
for almost any project
Easy to use and understand,
professionals & hobbyists can
be productive within minutes.
Free software development
system and low-cost in-circuit
programming.
Variety of hardware, project
boards and kits to suit your
application.
Digital, analog, serial RS232,
1-Wire™, and I2C facilities.
PC connectivity.
Applications include:
Datalogging
Robotics
Measurement & instruments
Motor & lighting control
Farming & agriculture
Internet server
Wireless links
Colour sensing
Fun games
of such a scheme are probably lower
power transmission losses and less
visual pollution, a more disbursed
power generation system (greater
disaster tolerance plus lower losses in
power transmission) plus ‘base load’
generation becomes less of an issue.
Schemes such as off-peak hot water
would not be required to soak up the
spinning reserve power generation as
gas turbines are basically best used for
full load/turned off systems.
And why are trees seen as the only
way to recapture carbon from the atmosphere? Surely faster and denser
growing plants such as sugar cane
would make more sense. Grow the
cane, process the cane and remove the
sugar and bury the fibre pulp. The sugar
can be used to make fuel for use in a
co-generation system or be used as a
source of hydrogen for fuel cells.
As seems to be so common these
days, whenever something is proposed
by a government department or some
group or other, it seems that the proponents have a vested interest in their
proposals.
Ron Powell,
Minchinbury, NSW.
Comment: some recent proposals for
solar power involve the use of molten
salt as the heat storage and transfer
medium to run steam-powered generators. This would probably be more
efficient and practical than any electrolysis scheme.
Comment on Atten
oscilloscope review
Distributed in Australia by
Microzed Computers
Pty Limited
Phone 1300 735 420
Fax 1300 735 421
www.microzed.com.au
6 Silicon Chip
I enjoyed reading the review of the
ATTEN ADS7062C low-cost colour
digital storage oscilloscope in the
February 2008 issue supplied by our
company for your evaluation. It was
refreshing to see that the reviewer really knew how to drive a DSO.
There was one minor point however
that could easily be missed. The oscilloscope is supplied with switched x1/
x10 probes. It is possible to manually
adjust the setting on the sensitivity to
correct the readout on the screen for
different probe attenuation settings.
The scope actually operates from
2mV/div to 5V/div. This is displayed
when set for use with an “x1” probe.
It can even be set to work with a x100
probe.
In the case of the review, it must
have been set for a x10 probe. In case
any of your readers got the wrong
impression or understood they could
put in signals of 400V directly at 50V/
div without a x10 probe, I just thought
I had better point out the true scope
performance. As mentioned several
times in the article, it’s the same as
other more expensive scopes.
Charles Holtom,
Managing Director,
Trio Smartcal Pty Ltd.
www.triosmartcal.com.au
Valve radio of
considerable interest
I found the article by Keith Walters
on building a 3-valve radio (SILICON
CHIP, January 2008) from everyday
materials of considerable interest.
I have made valve shields using the
tin-plate from tin cans. Just cut a suitable piece of tin-plate, wrap it around
a piece of dowel a little smaller than
the diameter of a valve and let it spring
out to suit the valve size. Maybe you
could solder the edge of the shield or
leave it as is, and solder a wire from
the shield to the chassis as Keith did.
Keith could have even used 6BL8
valves all the way through the set, as
the 6BL8 or 6U8 make quite an acceptable audio output valve.
Rodney Champness,
Mooroopna, Vic.
Energy efficiency
is just a marketing tool
I have been following some of
the debate and articles on energy in
your magazine. Our electricity usage
equates to about $30 a month, up somewhat because of the equipment I use
for my research. Our energy efficiency
is achieved without double-glazing,
we use quite a few incandescent lights
and we have no insulation in either
roof or walls. Instead, we employ
principles of microclimate, ventilation, daylight, etc.
I am doubtful that efforts to promote energy efficiency in homes and
workplaces will have any overall beneficial effect; just as energy efficiency
siliconchip.com.au
More on the
Peter Seligman articles
After reading the Peter Seligman
articles and the response by Dave
Waplington (SILICON CHIP, February 2008) and Peter’s subsequent
comments, I need to add a couple
of points.
First, it is likely that within the
next 10 years we will see geo-sequestration of carbon dioxide commence
in Australia and obviously, the CO2
will be sourced from power stations,
not moving vehicles. The argument
that the electric vehicle just shifts
the source of emissions may have
to be revised, as it actually shifts
the emissions to where they can be
more easily contained.
Secondly, Peter Seligman says
LPG and natural gas are similar
and makes comparisons between
LPG vehicles and natural gas power
stations. Natural gas burnt in the
power stations is mostly methane
(CH4) whereas LPG is mainly a mixture of propane and butane (C3H8
& C4H10). These are derived from
the condensate of the raw natural
gas and comprise about 5% of its
volume. Petrol is about equivalent
to octane (C8H18) or higher, and
usually also contains branched and
cyclic hydrocarbons.
It is clear that the higher the molecular weight of the hydrocarbon
fuel, the higher is the proportion of
carbon, so that while CO2 emissions
from burning methane are about half
those from petrol or diesel, those
from LPG are only slightly better. A
rough calculation I did when working on this subject at Mitsubishi
indicated a CO2 reduction of about
10-15%. This is not to be sneezed
at but is not in the same league as
natural gas.
It is possible to convert vehicles to
run on natural gas but filling stations
are scarce. I understand that there is
only one here in Adelaide. About 20
years ago, the gas supply company
SAGASCO (now taken over by Origin Energy) was experimenting with
a small home compressor which
could recharge a CNG vehicle tank
from the gas mains. The compressors
were made by Sulzer of Switzerland
but SAGASCO didn’t push the idea,
perhaps because of the road tax
problem.
They reported that their CNG vehicles such as Falcon utes and vans
had reasonably good driveability but
somewhat reduced power and range
compared to LPG.
David Inkster,
Meadows, SA.
We’re told we make
the best speakers
in the world…
Now you can too
“The best speakers
I have ever heard”
DVD Now
“The best bass
in the world”
Rolling Stone Magazine
“We have yet to hear
another system that
sounds as good”
Best Buys Home Theatre
in transport will not turn the tide of
increased consumption.
I was disappointed but not surprised
to read of the debacle regarding incandescent lights in Australia. Here in NZ
we have an equally stupid new law
requiring double-glazing.
The reality is, I strongly suggest,
that energy conservation will simply
end up as a marketing tool. In other
words, “more product” is the underlying philosophy, backed up by the iron
hand of legislation.
Stephen Butcher,
Carterton, NZ.
Energy saving can be illusory
Following on from the topics on
energy savings, there was a recent
story on ‘Today Tonight’ covering the
dangers of leaving devices on stand-by
power. In particular, this story targeted
TVs which when left on standby have a
high risk of starting fires. In the story, a
siliconchip.com.au
brief mention was made about a device
called the “Power Genie” developed
by Electronic System Integrators Pty
Ltd and used to switch off devices at
a single point – see http://www.powergenie.com.
I have looked at the site on the
Power Genie with some interest and
I am left wondering. They are selling
this product on the idea that it turns
devices off centrally, yet looking at
its operation, it is constantly plugged
into power and you have a controlling device to turn it on (ie, you have
to leave it on standby to then operate
by remote). So in effect, it’s a product
sold on reducing and saving power and
also turning off devices on stand-by,
yet this device itself seems to need to
be on standby.
What is the benefit of such a device
over, say, a power-board with a switch
to turn off everything?’
Perhaps the true workings of this
Seven models
from $769pr
www.vaf.com.au
FreeCall 1800 818 882
vaf<at>vaf.com.au
March 2008 7
Mailbag: continued
Electric vehicles
not yet available
Recently I decided to sell my
Toyota sedan and to make a serious
attempt to import an electric vehicle. In Cape Town, this proved to
be practically impossible and after
several months, I gave up.
Even if it had been possible to
import one, I wonder whether any
one would have been capable of
servicing and repairing it. Instead,
I imported a Bajaj Pickup from India, a successor of the original 1948
Vespa Ape, which is serviced and repaired locally. So far, fuel efficiency
is 3l/100km. Compare this with
5.6-15l/100km for a typical sedan.
Not only that but it is very useful
and great fun if one isn’t deterred
by a top speed of about 60km/h! So
here is someone who aspired to an
electric vehicle but the times did not
yet favour it.
Thomas Scarborough,
Cape Town, South Africa.
device could be covered in an article
in SILICON CHIP. This could then flow
onto a project on something better
which you could position anywhere
and centrally turn a number of devices
off (and where the device itself does
not need to be controlled by another
device to turn on).
I am beginning to find that this
whole issue about saving energy and
the environment is becoming a big
‘con’ on society, with everyone getting on the bandwagon and using it
as either a political grab or as a means
of sucking more hard-earned income
from individual consumers. If the
world governments really wanted to
improve the environment, then the
first point of the agenda is to release
our reliance on oil and fossil fuels.
I was dumbfounded by a report
which said that we should be taxed
to force new ‘green’ technologies.
http://www.news.com.au/business/
story/0,23636,22471121-462,00.html
Flavio Spedalieri,
Frenchs Forest, NSW.
Comment: SILICON CHIP has produced
8 Silicon Chip
Comment: it would certainly be economical but we like the protection
of a real motor vehicle with lots of
airbags and structural crash protection – which means that we might
be able to have a major collision
and still come through relatively
unscathed.
two projects which are relevant: (1) the
PowerUp in July 2003 and the USB
Power Switch in the November 2004
issue. See also the Remote Controlled
Mains Switch in this issue. It can be
used in conjunction with a powerboard.
Efficiency question on Signature
Series loudspeakers
There appears to be an error in the
sensitivity of the Signature Series Kit
Loudspeaker article. I have no doubt
that these are efficient speakers and I
know the tweeter is capable of the efficiency quoted, however the woofer
is not.
The speakers are reported to have
an efficiency of 92.5dB/1m/1W. This
is not possible as the drivers only
have an efficiency of 88dB/1m/2.83V
(or ~87dB/1m/1W with a 6-ohm
minimum impedance), so for the 260
series speakers with parallel drivers,
the woofers will have a sensitivity of
~90dB/1m/1W or ~93dB/1m/2.83V.
Although the 2.83V measurement
is more realistic for normal use, as
almost all amplifiers are voltage controlled, quoting it as a 1W figure is still
misrepresentation. Having said that,
the realistic figure of 90dB/1m/1W is
still very respectable and I commend
you and Russell Storey on a very
well-designed speaker. There would
be very few commercial speakers that
will come close to the level of the
Signature Series.
Chris Lister,
Brisbane, Qld.
Russell Storey comments: the 260
Ribbon Speaker was measured using
an LMS Speaker Analyser which is
calibrated in true SPL dB (speaker
pressure level). A B&K laboratory reference microphone pressure calibrator <at> 94 SPL dB is used to calibrate
the microphone and LMS Speaker
Analyser measurement system before any measurement is made. A
constant amplitude sinewave sweep
set to 2.83V RMS across the speaker
terminals is used as a reference point
only. The microphone distance is set
to one metre, centred on the tweeter
axis. Up to 40 different readings are
taken over a period of two hours and
then averaged.
The 260 sensitivity is quoted at
92.5dB SPL under all of the above
conditions and is an average over the
400Hz to 10kHz region.
Ambient temperature is the most important factor in measuring any loudspeaker system; this was set at 22°C.
SPL dB of any transducer (speaker)
can vary by as much as ±3dB to ±6dB
in the ambient temperature range
from 8-35°C. Other factors that change
transducer measurement readings are
humidity, barometric pressure and the
effect they have on the microphone
capsule, transducer motor (magnet)
system, voice coil, compliance of
the cone and spider materials and
heating losses in component in the
crossover.
Measuring any loudspeaker transducer or speaker system’s response
and specifications is like measuring a
“sponge with a pair of metal callipers“.
Every time you measure the sponge
diameter you will get a different set
of readings.
Russell Storey,
Stones Sound Studio.
http://www.stonessoundstudio.
com.au/
SC
siliconchip.com.au
Perhaps you are blissfully unaware of it –
but the Australian Government plans to progressively switch off
all analog TV transmitters, starting in less than two years time.
And High Definition digital TV programs are now being shown
on “free to air” commercial, ABC and SBS TV. Those programs
are not available via Standard Definition digital tuners or settop boxes. So what do you need to do?
Y
ou might have seen adverts on
the Seven & Ten network stating
that their new High Definition
(HD) TV programs are now available.
New Zealand is also converting, with
HD Digital on air in all major population centres, ready for the start of the
Beijing Olympics on 8th August 2008.
Perhaps you have been thinking that
you will be able to get the new HD
programs with your existing standard
definition (SD) set-top box (STB) or
SD digital tuner. Well, think again. It
doesn’t work that way.
If you want to see HD programs, you
will need an HD tuner, even if your
present display cannot show them in
the needle-sharp focus of HD.
siliconchip.com.au
In Australia there are HD and SD
receivers. SD programming will
eventually die out with the advent of
HD-only programming but an HD STB
can produce an SD signal for analog
receivers. So even if you decide to stay
with your present analog TV set, it will
still be possible to watch all the new
high-definition free-to-air programs,
provided that you have an HD STB.
The clock is definitely ticking on
analog TV broadcasts. Senator Conroy, the Minister for Broadband, Communications and the Digital Economy,
has set the switch-off date for metropolitan analog TV as December 2009,
with all analog transmissions to cease
by 2013.
So there is no escaping it, if you
want free-to-air TV programs in the
near future, you are going to have
to “go digital” and realistically, that
means “go HD”.
But why wait? Why not enjoy all the
advantages that HD TV has to offer,
right now? The main advantages are
more programs, much better picture
and sound quality and no ghosting.
If you want to watch HD programs,
you must obtain:
1) A wide screen TV which incorporates an HD tuner or
2) An HD Set Top Box (STB) which
will receive digital signals and convert them into a form a conventional
receiver can display or a standard
March 2008 9
You’ll need an HD set-top box
if your TV doesn’t have one built in.
But don’t despair: they won’t cost an arm and a leg!
This Tevion brand HD STB was on sale earlier this year for less than $100
(see the review in this issue). And we’ve seen them for $50 or less on eBay!
video recorder can record via its
AV inputs or
3) An HD Personal Video Recorder
(PVR). This device will receive
digital signals and display on a conventional or wide-screen display
(and/or record them if you wish).
And while it might seem obvious,
you need a suitable antenna to receive
the digital signals. Your existing antenna may not be good enough.
If you live in a home unit, your
building’s Master Antenna Television
(MATV) system will need upgrading
to pass the channels used by digital
TV.
The cheapest and best way to do this
is for all residents to obtain either a
STB or PVR first. They may not receive
all stations at this stage. Then get the
body corporate/building owner to
upgrade the MATV system to digital
channels. The installation should be
made according to Australian Standard AS1367: 2007.
The cheapest option is to install
STBs near the antenna instead of
retuning the channel amplifiers. One
STB will be required for each digital
channel. The STBs will be used to
convert the digital signals back to
standard definition analog.
However, this approach will prevent you seeing High Definition
signals and multi-channel sound on
your expensive new TV. And it will
probably prevent you seeing the new
HD and the supplementary channels
already available. See www.dba.org.
au/index.asp?sectionID=26
If you live in a free-standing home
or dual-occupancy dwelling, you will
need to check to see if you get reliable digital reception, particularly in
the rain.
Check that the picture does not
break up into little squares, the sound
not go off and on or that the “no signal”
sign appears.
If any of these things occur, then
you require an antenna designed for
digital reception (not “digital-ready”)
in your viewing area. The antenna
cabling may also need replacing. We
hope to have more to say on digital
antennas next month.
HD set-top boxes are getting cheaper
all the time. Over the Christmas
period, Aldi stores had an HD STB
available on special at just $99 (down
from $119) while Coles supermarkets
have had them even cheaper at $79.
You could also pick one up on eBay
for less than $50 (but watch those
postage charges!).
At the same time, we have seen
standard definition (SD) STBs on sale
for as little as $35.
However, in view of the above remarks about HD programming, we see
little point in buying an SD STB. In
fact, we forecast that once the general
public understands their limitations,
SD STBs will shortly disappear from
the market.
PVRs are also becoming cheaper by
the day and they are a very good option
if you want to record a HD program
at a particular time while you watch
another HD (or SD) program. This is
easy with most PVRs since they usually have two inbuilt tuners.
PVRs are similar to a VCR but with
some distinct advantages. The first of
these is the Electronic Program Guide
(EPG). This is where the broadcaster
sends out via their transmissions the
names of all programs to be shown for
the coming week. You can then select
the programs you wish to record by
name. No more worrying about start
and stop times, channel number etc.
Another advantage is Time Slip recording, which enables you to pause
the program you are watching, while
the recording process continues. You
can then start playing where you
left off while the recording is being
completed.
Since the recordings are made on a
very large hard disk (typically 160GB
or 250GB), there is no waiting for a
tape to wind to the right place; it is
just like playing a DVD.
Here’s the rear view of the STB above. At left is the standard coax antenna input and loop output sockets. Alongside is the
coaxial (digital audio) and S-video socket, followed by the Y, Pb and Pr component video sockets (labelled HD OUT). The
next three sockets are component video (yellow) and L/R audio (white and red). Immediately alongside this is a D-socket
for use with a VGA computer monitor. The next four sockets are the interesting ones: DVI out (for projectors, etc), the
HDMI output we’ve discussed in the text; a USB socket for USB devices and finally, the optical, or TOSlink audio socket.
10 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
PRIME
There are many
ways to “skin a cat”
– some better than
others. If you have
the option, the best
is to use an HDMI
cable to connect
a personal video
recorder to the TV –
especially if it is an
HD type.
ELECTRONICS
Est. 1987
â
115 Compact DMM
3 YEAR
WARRANTY
CAT III 600V
True RMS
AC/DC Volts 600V
AC/DC Amps 10A
Resistance
Continuity
Frequency
Capacitance
List Price
$245.00
Diode Test
Analog Bar Graph
Backlight
Min/Max/Avg
Display Hold
Auto/Manual Range
Holster
Our Price
$199.00
179/EDA2 Combo Kit
LIMITED
LIFETIME
WARRANTY
CAT III 1000V
CAT IV 600V
Subtitling for the hard of hearing’s
data is also recorded along with the
program so you can choose whether
you display subtitles on playback or
not.
HDMI or component video?
HD STBs and PVRs should be connected to your TV set or projector by
HDMI or component video cables.
HDMI stands for “high definition
multimedia interface”.
But which one should you use?
HDMI or “component video”?
HDMI has the following advantages:
• It can carry the three colour signals and up to eight channels of sound
siliconchip.com.au
on a single cable.
• It can tell the display what type of
signals is being sent so that the display
can automatically adjust.
• It can convey control commands
for other devices. So for example, a
single remote control can be used to
control the PVR, etc.
• It can carry the High Definition
Copy Protection (HDCP) signals.
There is talk of only outputting Full
Definition (1920 x 1080p) signals to
the HDMI output only. This will particularly affect High Definition DVDs
such as BlueRay and may actually be a
drawback in the future, as far as most
users are concerned, since HDCP is a
copy prevention method.
Kit Contains
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
Fluke 179 True RMS DMM
TL224 SureGripTM Silcone Test Lead
Set
TL910 Electronic Test Probe Set
AC280 SureGripTM Hook Clip Set
TPAK Magnetic Hanger
80BK Intergrated DMM Temp Probe
C35 Soft Meter Case
List Price
$585.00
Our Price
$499.00
Prices exclude GST
Call for a 2008 Fluke Catalogue
www.prime-electronics.com.au
Brisbane (07) 3252 7466
Sydney (02) 9704 9000
March 2008 11
For the complete “home theatre”
experience, you’ll need a 5.1
channel amplifier along with
the DVD and PVR. While the
subwoofer is shown centre
rear in this diagram, it can in
fact go just about anywhere
as low frequency sound is, for
all intents and purposes, nondirectional.
Y, Pb and Pr signals.
The sharpness of the image will be
controlled by the resolution of the
display but the accuracy of the colour
should be a little better using HDMI
compared to component video.
In essence, your ultimate picture
quality will depend more on the resolution and video conversion processes
inside your video monitor or projector
than on whether you have selected
a component video or HDMI cable
connection.
HDMI uses only one cable
• The signals are not converted into
analog. This is an advantage because
the display will have to digitise component signals, so that the image can
be stored for display. Thus digital to
analog and an analog to digital conversions are eliminated.
• Finally, it allows the transfer of the
xvYCC colour signals to the display.
This gives a greater range of strong
colours, if they are present on the disc.
But in spite of the above, there is
presently no clear-cut advantage for
HDMI over “component video”. While
HDMI is a digital format, it does not
have error correction and therefore
long cable runs can be more problematical, with possible signal dropouts,
than the analog “component video”
connection.
To explain, both HDMI and analog
component video deliver signals as
three discrete colour components,
together with sync information which
allows the TV or projector to produce
the video display.
HDMI delivers these via three data
channels in a format called TMDS
(Transition Minimised Differential
Signalling). The TMDS format basically involves a blue channel to which
horizontal and vertical sync are added
and separate green and red channels.
TMDS involves two schemes to
minimise noise and interference.
“Transition Minimised” refers to the
conversion of the signal to Grey code,
12 Silicon Chip
which only has one bit change at a
time in the channel. So if interference
is picked up, all channels receive it
and it is ignored.
At the same time, it employs “Differential Signalling” whereby when a
“1” is being sent one wire of the pair
goes to +250mV while the other goes
-250mV with respect to earth. They
reverse when a “0” is being sent. This
gives noise immunity. Error correction
is also applied to the sound and control
signals (but not to the colour signals).
The signals are sent as identifiable
packets, so the same wires are used
for picture and sound.
An HD colour signal consists of a
luminance (Y) signal. It shows as a
black, grey and white signal in sharp
detail. The picture is then “coloured
in”, by using a Pr signal which colours
it either red or aqua, or a Pb signal
which colours it blue or yellow. The
green and purple colours can be derived from the above three signals.
Component video is not much different, with the analog colour information also split three ways: luminance
(the “Y” or green channel, representing the total brightness of the image);
Red minus Luminance (the “Pr” or red
channel); and Blue minus Luminance
(the “Pb” or blue channel).
The horizontal and vertical sync
pulses are delivered on the Y channel. The video display calculates the
values of red, green and blue from the
HDMI does have the convenience
of only using one cable connection instead of three in the case of component
video (plus an extra two for the left
and right audio channels) but when
you consider that component video
cables are always moulded together
to give one flat “cable”, albeit with
three RCA connectors at each end, the
advantage is small.
Nor is there much advantage if you
are using a video projector since you
don’t have to worry about connecting
audio cables (although you do have to
connect separate audio cables to the
amplifier).
HDMI cables are not normally
included when you purchase HD
equipment and have to be purchased
separately – and they are also more
expensive than equivalent high quality component video cables. In fact,
they are very expensive for lengths
between 10-25m. Cheap HDMI cables
can be a problem at lengths above 5m,
with the most frequent symptom being
“sparkles” in the picture followed by
complete dropout.
For HDMI cables longer than 1015m, you may need an HDMI repeater
such as the one sold by Jaycar Electronics (Cat AC-1698 at $79.95). This
is powered by a plugpack.
HDMI cables also present problems
for installers. This is because you presently cannot buy HDMI cable and then
fit it with connectors – you must buy
the complete cable with connectors fitted at each end. This can make it very
difficult to pull such a cable through
wall cavities without damage.
Long component video leads can
also be a problem, especially if they
use cheap cable. The result is picture
blurring.
For projectors, component connections are an alternative to the high
cost of HDMI. However, blurring of
siliconchip.com.au
A selection of some of the cables you’re likely to come across.
At left is an S-Video cable, while to its right is an HDMI cable.
A composite video cable is next, with its three RCA plugs (yellow is video, red is right
audio and white is left audio). Finally, the cable at far right is a combination component
video/audio cable – the green plug is Y, blue is Pb and red is Pr. This cable can also
handle composite video (yellow) and stereo audio (red and white).
the vertical edges in the picture will
occur if they are too long.
If you have insufficient HDMI
inputs then you can use component
inputs, but also feed the sound into
the display as well.
The other option is to use a home
theatre amplifier to do all switching,
provided it can delay the sound for
the delay in the display.
In practice, we think that the decision whether to use a component
video or HDMI connection will
depend on how many HDMI inputs
your TV or projector has. At present,
video projectors come with only one
HDMI input and many HD TVs are
the same. So if you have several HD
video sources (eg, HD STB, PVR and
DVD), you will probably end up using
a mixture of component video and
HDMI cables.
The most recent “upmarket” HDMI
plasma and LCD HD sets may have
two or three HDMI inputs so there is
less of a problem with these models.
If you have one of these, it is best
to feed all sources to the display, then
take the sound from the display. This
also has the advantage of avoiding
problems with “lip sync” whereby
the video is delayed with respect to
the sound.
By the way, using S-video or composite video cables for HD connections
is really a waste of time and money,
unless you are using an analog TV set.
What about Surround Sound?
If you want to get the complete experience, then you also need a home
theatre amplifier and all the necessary
loudspeakers. If you purchase an HD
STB or PVR, it will have a coax or
optical output which can be fed to the
Dolby decoder in your home theatre
receiver.
However, consider that unless you
frequently watch “action” movies,
there is no real need for surround
sound; your TV’s inbuilt speakers will
be quite adequate for the purpose.
Even if you do watch the occasional
“action” movie, a good quality stereo
pair of speakers and your existing
system amplifier can still give a very
satisfactory aural result.
In fact, if you have a limited budget,
as most people do, then our advice is
to buy the biggest HD set (or choose
a HD video projector) and leave the
decision about a surround system to
a later date – if ever!
If you do decide to go for the full
home theatre experience with multiple speakers, go for the best home
theatre receiver you can afford. It will
also solve any problems with switching of HD signal sources.
Most plasma and LCD TVs have
stereo sound systems but many have
relatively poor sound due to restricted
speaker sizes.
HD programs are broadcast with the
option of two sound systems. The first
of these is MPEG2 which is stereo only.
The second is AC-3 or Dolby Digital
5.1 which carries six channels: left,
centre and right front, as well as left
and right rear.
The 0.1 is the low frequency channel which is normally fed to an active
subwoofer. Typically, when broadcast
AC-3 has a greater dynamic range than
SC
MPEG2.
NEXT MONTH:
In part 2 of this feature, we’ll look at
some of the traps for young players in
HDTV reception – for example, is your
old analog TV antenna suitable for
digital? The answer is . . . probably not!
SUPPLIERS OF
Contact
PH:
1800 331 301
Email: info<at>alvin.com.au
Web: www.alvin.com.au
siliconchip.com.au
Digital STBs’
MATV Systems
Audio Distribution
Telephone and Data Accessories
Digital and Analogue TV Antennas
Digital and Analogue Interconnect Cables
DA-5000
Digital Antenna
March 2008 13
Got an analog TV set?
You’re going to need
an HD Set Top Box!
If you currently have an analog TV set or a digital
projector and don’t want to change it, you will need a
high definition set top box to watch HD TV broadcasts –
now and more importantly in the future.
By LEO SIMPSON
W
ith that in mind, we purchased a Tevion TEV8200
HD STB from our local Aldi
store. This is one of the cheapest HD
STBs currently available and has all
the features that you are likely to want.
With a recommended retail price of
$119 (including GST) and occasionally
available on special at $99, the Tevion
HD STB is hard to go past. It is quite a
bit larger than typical SD STBs and is
quite heavy to boot.
Its front panel has six pushbuttons to
control the various on-screen menus, to
select channels and control volume. But
after the initial setup, there is no need
to ever use the front panel controls.
The rear panel is of more interest
because the number of video output
connections is impressive. In fact, the
array of connectors on the rear panel
is likely to be quite daunting for any
non-technical user.
It has the standard male and female
coax connectors for the antenna input
fly lead and an output to VCR, TV or
whatever. To connect an analog TV,
there are RCA sockets for composite
video and L & R stereo audio, S-video
and component video.
Most analog TV sets will just use
the composite video output (yellow
socket) and the left/right stereo outputs
(red & white). If your set only has a
The TV Channel Manager screen shows the channels
that are available together with a preview of the channel
selected, in this case ABC HDTV. Note the availability of
the D44 data signal channels.
14 Silicon Chip
mono input, use the left audio (white)
output.
In the (these days most unlikely)
event that your analog set does not
have audio/video (A/V) inputs, you
will need an RF modulator to connect
to the standard antenna input. Both
Altronics and Jaycar Electronics have
suitable RF modulators.
For connection to home theatre receivers, there are two digital outputs,
one via a SPDIF coax (RCA) socket
and one via a TOSLINK (optical) connector.
Having the two options is good since
you may find that one of the digital
inputs in your home theatre receiver
This screen is a program guide showing what is available
over most parts of Sydney, including the D44 Datacast
channels. The latter include weather, federal parliament, a
TV buying channel, a Christian channel and so on.
siliconchip.com.au
is already in use and so you can use
the alternative.
In case you were wondering, SPDIF
stands for Sony/Philips Digital Interface. TOSLINK is a registered trademark of Toshiba Corporation and hence
the origin of the name: TOShiba-LINK.
For connection to a PC, there is a
DVI socket. For connection to a PC
monitor, you can use the VGA RGB/
HV D socket, together with the L & R
audio outputs.
For connection to an LCD or DLP
video projector, you can use the component video or HDMI digital outputs.
Of course most good projectors will
also take composite video, S-video or
RGB/HV inputs but if you want highdefinition pictures, you need to use the
component video or HDMI signals.
Setting up the Tevion TEV8200 is
straightforward. First, you need to
select the video output which you
have connected to your TV, projector
or whatever.
To do this, you press the FUNC button on the remote control twice within
four seconds and this brings up a fourdash display on the STB’s front panel
readout. You then press one of the
coloured buttons to select the output:
RED for PAL (ie, analog TV); GREEN for
VGA; YELLOW for Component Video
and BLUE for DVI/HDMI mode. You
can also use the Left/Right buttons to
select the video resolution you want
such as 1080i (interlace), 720p (progressive scan) and so on.
siliconchip.com.au
For best picture from a video projector, it is desirable to set the STB’s
output video resolution to the “native” video resolution of the projector,
although most of the better projectors
will do a pretty good job of scaling
the signal to suit. Most HD projectors will also automatically recognise
interlaced or progressive scan signals.
Once you have set the video output,
you can ignore the front panel display
of the STB, as it will
display all the information you want
via the video screen.
The next step is to get the STB to
scan all the available channels. You can
do this manually but it is far quicker
and easier to just let the STB get on
with it. Afterwards you can decide
to get rid of channels you don’t want,
rename them, change their order or
whatever.
Inside view of the Tevion TEV8200: note the large and complex PC boards and
the large number SMDs and electrolytic capacitors. The electros look as though
they might have been hit by a mini-tornado, don’t they?
March 2008 15
Initially though, just let the STB do
it. It will then come up with a display
of all the channels available in your
location, together with their signal
strength and quality.
It is here that an STB can demonstrate surprisingly good results. In
my setup I have a 4-bay UHF antenna
with direct line of sight to Sydney’s
North Head (Mosman/Manly) translator and it gives good reception of the
existing analog stations (ABC, SBS,
7, 9 & 10).
The Tevion picked up the equivalent
digital channels as you would expect,
plus a brace of digital datacast channels (D44) which are available only
in Sydney at the time of writing. I
certainly did not expect to pick up the
D44 channels – they must be coming
in from the side of the UHF array. (For
a signal coverage map, see www.dba.
org.au/uploads/images/NSW_Syd_
Datacast_coverage_map.jpg
As well, it also picked up the Prime
and WIN digital and HD channels from
Wollongong, about 85km to the south
of my location on Sydney’s northern
beaches.
These latter channels do come and
go at my location and it is possible
that the intermittent reception was
a case of summer-time tropospheric
“ducting”.
Suffice to say that there is no equivalent DX (ie, long distance) reception
of UHF analog channels from Wollongong and SBS and ABC digital signals
didn’t make it either.
The really good point about digital
TV reception is that, provided the STB
can pick up the signal, the picture is
rock steady with no sign of ghosting
or noise. Even if you have pretty good
analog TV reception, the transition to
digital is a revelation, with the picture
quality the same as obtained from a
standard definition DVD, depending
on your video signal connection and
the quality of your monitor.
The Tevion STB has two further
benefits when the signal strength momentarily dips, as it may do on the
weaker signals. Instead of the annoying
random pixellation of the picture, the
whole picture freezes and then a panel
may be displayed with the message
“No signal”. Furthermore, there are no
loud zaps or cracks from the speakers
as the sound drops out. Instead, the
sound is muted, without any clicks.
Nor are there any clicks when the
sound is restored.
Having written that, I noted than
when watching weak HD broadcasts
the picture does sometimes also suffer
from momentary freezing and pixellation. Still, it is not as severe as I have
noted on other (SD) STBs.
For my checks I connected the
Tevion to an older Panasonic 68cm
analog TV (TC-68P22A) and a Panasonic AE700 LCD projector. On the
analog TV, via the composite video
connection, I had the satisfaction of
seeing HD TV broadcasts without
problems, although the picture quality
was no better than noise-free PAL, as
you would expect.
Via the Panasonic projector and
the component video connection, the
pictures are first class, even on standard definition. In fact, I must admit,
after watching the very large pictures
This is what usually happens during loss of signal. The
picture freezes and you get a panel with the message, “No
signal”. Occasionally the picture becomes pixellated.
16 Silicon Chip
available via an HD LCD projector, I
still have problems coming to grips
with the excellent picture quality – it
still seems too good to be true. For one
who has experienced the limitations of
black and white and then PAL colour
TV reception, the results from digital
TV are a revelation, as noted above.
In spite of that, it must be said that
the picture quality from most of the
supposed HD programs is apparently
no different from that of SD broadcasts.
You only have to see the outstanding quality of the so-called “HD loops”
broadcast by some of the commercial
networks to see the dramatic difference
with true HD.
I should also note that the Panasonic
AE700 is not a “true HD” projector.
True HD requires a picture resolution
of 1920 x 1080 pixels or better.
Aspect ratio
Another point of interest with the
Tevion is that you can select the picture
aspect ratio to be shown on your TV
set or display. You have three choices,
4:3, 16:9 or Panscan.
This is perhaps the biggest disadvantage of watching digital TV on
an analog set with a 4:3 picture tube;
no matter which aspect ratio setting
you choose, the results are less than
optimum.
If you choose 16:9, you will have
black strips at top and bottom of the
picture, just as you do, for example,
with current analog broadcasts of ABC
and SBS news programs. If you choose
4:3, you get a 4:3 picture, within a black
rectangle – not very satisfying.
On changing channels, you get this electronic program
guide for a few seconds. Lately, though, we have noticed
increasing instances of “no information” .
siliconchip.com.au
The rear view of the Tevion TEV8200 shows a comprehensive array of video and digital output connectors. Note that DVI
and HDMI connectors are included; essential if you are to get the best picture from LCD and DLP projectors.
And if you chose panscan, the whole
screen area is filled but inevitably, you
lose the sides of the broadcast picture.
Oh, well...never mind.
As an aside, the commercial networks have yet to standardise their
program and advertising content and
the aspect ratio can vary between
16:9, 4:3, letter-box and so on. It is
also very annoying for people with 4:3
sets when watching sports – the 16:9
format means that sport scores often
cannot be seen.
Also on the negative side, sound
quality appears to be only average and
there is a fair amount of high frequency
“frizzle” and a low level tone which
is probably related to the switchmode
power supply.
You have two choices for sound
quality by the way, although the modes
are limited: stereo (MPEG1/2) via the
audio outputs or Dolby AC-3 via the
SPDIF connection. Presumably, the
AC-3 mode would be free of highfrequency frizzle but we did not test it.
The remote control provides 20-level
adjustment and muting.
Incidentally, all the screen shots of
the Tevion STB shown in this article
were taken with a 6-megapixel digital
camera (Fuji Finepix S6500fd) from
the Panasonic analog TV mentioned
above.
One of the problems with taking
these shots was the strobing effect
between the TV scan rate and the
camera’s picture update, together with
the inevitable Moire patterns evident
because of the interference between
the camera’s CCD pixel structure and
the vertical slot makeup of the TV
screen (perhaps this might have been
reduced if the shots were taken at
siliconchip.com.au
maximum file size). A consequence of
the strobing is a tendency to get a light
band through the centre of the picture,
in spite of using a slow shutter speed
of 1/15 second. So while some of the
various off-screen shots may look fairly
poor, the actual picture quality was
generally very good, as already noted.
Incidentally, all of these picture
problems could have been avoided if
I had taken the screen shots using the
Panasonic projector, particularly if its
“freeze frame” feature was used. But
this would have defeated the purpose,
as I wanted to show what is displayed
on a typical analog TV set.
Interestingly, I found that the Aspect
Ratio selection from the Tevion STB
over-ruled the aspect ratio control on
the Panasonic projector – not sure why
that happens.
One aspect of digital TV that is
not well-known is that digital radio
services are available from ABC and
SBS. Also available in rural areas is
the Mytalk datacasting service. See
www.mytalk.com.au/NewDesign/
Pages/Datacasting.asp
Finally, the Tevion offers the ability
to view subtitles via teletext and it has
a selection of simple video games –
perish the thought!
Inside the box
A look inside the box shows the
Tevion HD STB is far more complex
than typical standard definition STBs.
It has a large main PC board which is
packed with surface mount devices
and a surprising number of electrolytic
capacitors. I have to say that QC in assembly was a bit lacking: the electros
are soldered in every-which-way but
vertical!
The switchmode power supply
board is also quite large, again with
a number of electrolytic capacitors.
Interestingly, while the Tevion is
double-insulated, it is fitted with a
three-core mains cord and moulded
3-pin plug.
Power consumption of the Tevion
is listed as 20W. We measured power
consumption at 14W, dropping to
12W on standby. Why the small drop?
Surely, standby power should only
be a watt or two? This means that the
Tevion should be switched off at the
power socket when not in use. All settings are saved in non-volatile memory
when the power is off.
A USB socket on the rear panel is
included for software upgrades and
interestingly, the operating system is
Linux. The main chip is an ATI Xilleon
X210H.
Conclusion
If you don’t intend purchasing an
HD TV set in the near future, you
should consider purchasing an HD
STB such as this Tevion TEV8200.
For a relatively small outlay, you
will get the immediate benefits of
much better picture quality and a great
range of TV programs.
Sure, it’s not perfect and its standby
power use is on the high side but the
pictures outweigh the drawbacks.
And to save power, all you have
to do is turn it (and anything else
that goes to “standby” with a remote
control) off at the power point. Our
recent series of articles on power usage showed just how wasteful standby
power is – and how much (power AND
$$$) you can save with the simple step
of turning things off!
SC
March 2008 17
SILICON
CHIP
If you are seeing a blank page here, it is
more than likely that it contained advertising
which is now out of date and the advertiser
has requested that the page be removed to
prevent misunderstandings.
Please feel free to visit the advertiser’s website:
dicksmith.com.au
SILICON
CHIP
If you are seeing a blank page here, it is
more than likely that it contained advertising
which is now out of date and the advertiser
has requested that the page be removed to
prevent misunderstandings.
Please feel free to visit the advertiser’s website:
dicksmith.com.au
SILICON
CHIP
If you are seeing a blank page here, it is
more than likely that it contained advertising
which is now out of date and the advertiser
has requested that the page be removed to
prevent misunderstandings.
Please feel free to visit the advertiser’s website:
dicksmith.com.au
SILICON
CHIP
If you are seeing a blank page here, it is
more than likely that it contained advertising
which is now out of date and the advertiser
has requested that the page be removed to
prevent misunderstandings.
Please feel free to visit the advertiser’s website:
dicksmith.com.au
How to solder
SURFACEMOUNT
DEVICES
Many electronics enthusiasts hesitate to build projects
involving surface-mount devices (SMDs) because they’re
daunted by the prospect of soldering such tiny parts to a PC
board. But it can be done. Jim Rowe shows us how. . .
I
T’S TRUE THAT SMDs are not really intended for manual assembly.
They’re designed for automated
pick-and-place machines and reflow
soldering ovens.
The problem is that more and more
ICs and other components are becoming available only in SMD form. As
technology marches on, it’s becoming
necessary for everyone to get used to
working with SMDs.
222
1.5
3.00
'1206' CHIP
RESISTOR
1.5
0.6
3.00
'1206' CHIP
CAPACITOR
222
0.6
You may already be familiar with
the simpler SMDs like resistors, capacitors, diodes and transistors. Some
of these are shown in Fig.1. Note that
they’re all shown twice actual size,
for clarity.
We’ve used these in various projects
published in the last few years, and
shown how they can be soldered onto
a PC board: use a soldering iron with
a fine conical or ‘flattened conical’ tip
1.3
2.0
'0805' CHIP
RESISTOR
0.5
1.3
2.0
'0805' CHIP
CAPACITOR
0.5
1.25
1.7
1.0
SOD-323 DIODE
2.92
4.9
1.3
1.0
SOT-23 TRANSISTOR
OR DIODE
Fig.1: a selection of common SMD components, shown here twice full size
(if we showed them normal size they’d be hard to see in some cases!)
22 Silicon Chip
and very fine (0.71mm OD) resin-cored
wire solder.
Figs.2 & 3 show how this is done.
The basic idea is to hold the chip or
device in place while you tack-solder
one or two of its leads to hold it in
position. This then allows you to
solder all of the leads to their pads in
the usual way.
It needs to be done carefully and
fairly quickly, so you don’t damage
6.6
3.9
1.5
8-LEAD SOIC
6.1
2.3
D-PAK POWER TRANSISTOR
OR REGULATOR
siliconchip.com.au
either the SMD or the PC pads by
overheating. You also need to make
sure you don’t apply too much solder,
which can cause fine solder “bridges”
to short between pads or tracks.
If you do get solder bridges, they
can be removed by applying the end
of some fine de-soldering braid to the
top of the “bridge” and briefly applying the tip of your soldering iron to
the top of the braid, so the end of the
braid heats up to the solder’s melting
point and ‘sucks up’ the excess solder
by capillary action.
OK, so what is the real problem
with SMDs?
Um, it’s the large SMDs with umpteen dozen closely spaced pins.
TIP OF
TOOTHPICK
'HOLD DOWN'
SOLDERING IRON TIP
TINY DROP OF
SOLDER
UPPER TIP OF
CROSSOVER TWEEZER
'HOLD DOWN'
SOLDERING IRON TIP
SMD CHIP
COMPONENT
COPPER TRACK
AND PAD
1
LOWER TIP OF
CROSSOVER TWEEZER
PC BOARD
Holding SMD chip in place while
applying a tiny solder drop with
soldering iron tip to “tack” one end
SOLDER TACK NOW
HOLDING CHIP
IN PLACE
SOLDER
1
Holding SOT, SOD, SOIC
or similar semiconductor device
in place while tacking one pin
SOLDER TACKED LEAD
NOW HOLDING
DEVICE IN PLACE
SOLDER
2
Other end of SMD chip now
soldered to pad in normal way
2
Pin or pons on other side of device
now soldered to pads in normal way
3
First end finally
re-soldered in normal way
3
Pin on first side re-soldered,
others soldered in normal way
Fine-pitch ICs
More and more VLSI (very largescale integration) devices now come
in SMD packages like that shown opposite and those in Fig.4 – quad flat
packs (QFPs) with anywhere between
about 44 and 208 leads.
The lead pitch can be as fine as
0.4mm – less than 16% the pitch of
0.1”/2.54mm used in most familiar
‘dual in line’ IC packages.
The width of the leads can also
be as fine as 0.18mm (that’s right –
only 180mm!), so the actual spaces
between the leads can be as small as
0.22mm/220mm.
Now it is possible (just!) to solder
a 44-lead MQFP device with 0.8mm
pitch leads like that shown in Fig.4
using a fine-tipped soldering iron and
the technique shown on the right in
Fig.3.
That’s providing you are extremely
careful, have a very steady hand and
don’t mind having to use the soldering
braid to remove the almost-inevitable
solder bridges. If you can do this consistently, you are a champion!
The real problem arises when it
Fig.2: the basic steps involved in manually soldering smaller SMDs like
those shown in Fig.1, using a fine-tipped soldering iron and very fine resincored wire solder. The steps for resistors and capacitors (left) are much the
same as those for SOT, SOD and SOIC devices (right).
UPPER TIP OF
CROSSOVER TWEEZER
'HOLD DOWN'
SOLDERING IRON TIP
LOWER TIP OF
CROSSOVER TWEEZER
1
2
Holding down MQFP or similar
“Gull Wing” IC package while
tack-soldering one corner lead
Opposite diagonal pin of
device now tack-soldered in same
way, to locate all pins on their pads.
FINE (0.71mm OD)
RESIN CORE SOLDER
3
Close-up view of a 44-lead MQFP
device with 0.8mm pitch (lead
spacing), after being reflow soldered
using a low cost snack oven.
siliconchip.com.au
UPPER TIP OF
CROSSOVER TWEEZER
'HOLD DOWN'
First “tacked” pins now re-soldered,
others soldered in normal way.
SOLDERING IRON TIP
LOWER TIP OF
CROSSOVER TWEEZER
1
2
Holding down PLCC or similar
“J-lead” IC package while
tack-soldering one corner lead
Opposite diagonal pin of
device now tack-soldered in same
way, to locate all pins on their pads.
FINE (0.71mm OD)
RESIN CORE SOLDER
3
First “tacked” pins now re-soldered,
others soldered in normal way.
Fig.3: manual soldering of SMD ICs with lead pitches of 0.8mm or more
can be done in the same way if you’re VERY careful but be prepared for the
accidental creation of solder bridges between leads – and having to remove
them using solder wick. As you can see there’s not much difference in
approach between ‘gull wing’ and ‘J-lead’ devices.
March 2008 23
LEAD
PITCH
0.8mm
LEAD
WIDTH
0.38mm
10.0
LEAD
PITCH
0.5mm
14.0
LEAD
WIDTH
0.22mm
10.0
14.0
2.45
44-LEAD METRIC QUAD FLAT PACK (MQFP)
ALL DIMENSIONS IN MILLIMETRES
1.60
100-LEAD LOW PROFILE QUAD FLAT PACK
(LQFP100/SOT407-1)
(BOTH DEVICES SHOWN 2x ACTUAL SIZE)
Fig.4: the key dimensions of a 44-lead MQFP device compared with those
for a 100-lead LQFP device – both shown twice actual size for clarity. You
can see why the fine-pitch devices can’t be soldered in manually or even by
wave soldering.
comes to devices with lead pitches
of 0.4mm or 0.5mm, like the 100-lead
LQFP device shown in Fig.4. These
packages are not even suitable for
automated wave soldering, let alone
manual soldering. The leads and gaps
between them are just too narrow.
The only way to solder these devices is by reflow soldering. This process
involves applying solder paste to all
of the tiny pads on the board (using a
laser-cut stencil and squeegee system),
then placing the SMDs accurately in
position on the board. The boards are
then placed on a conveyor belt and
passed through an ‘IR reflow oven’ at
a controlled rate, using infrared radiant heating.
Inside the oven they move through
areas with temperatures set for preheating, followed by a ‘ramp up’ to
above the melting point of solder and
then a ‘ramp down’ to well below
the melting point. This is known
as a ‘reflow soldering profile’.
Using this approach, SMDs
with a lead pitch of 0.4mm
can be soldered to boards
safely and with a high degree
of reliability, at the same time
as all of the other SMD components.
The main drawback is
that a commercial IR reflow
oven is very expensive (many
thousands of dollars) and thus
beyond the reach of enthusiasts
and even many small manufacturers.
Getting laser-cut solder paste
stencils made from your PC
board CAD file is not cheap
either.
24 Silicon Chip
So the challenge is to find a much
cheaper way of soldering these finepitch SMDs into PC boards. Luckily,
there is a way!
amount of solder paste to every pad
on the PC board where an SMD lead
or contact area is to be soldered.
This is shown in the upper two diagrams of Fig.5. This technique simply
it isn’t practical for small manufacturers or enthusiasts.
A much simpler approach involves
applying a thin ‘stripe’ of paste along
the pads for the SMD leads, as shown
in the lowest diagram in Fig.5.
The stripe of paste is only a millimetre or so wide and can be applied
using a fine brush, a very narrow roller
applicator or a fine spatula with a 1mm
wide tip.
You’d think that applying a continuous stripe of solder paste in this way
would be ‘asking for trouble’ for it to
SOLDER
PASTE
SQUEEGEE
STENCIL
About solder paste
Solder paste is available from the
better electronics stores. It consists of
tiny spheres (<50mm in diameter) of
tin-lead solder (63% tin, 37% lead),
suspended in a water-soluble paste
or gel of flux.
It’s typically sold in fairly large plastic syringes, holding about 80 grams
of solder paste. This is actually far
too much for the average enthusiast,
because the ingredients in the flux
apparently have a shelf life of only six
months after manufacture, even when
stored in a refrigerator. Yet 80g of paste
is enough to solder many hundreds –
even thousands – of SMDs.
So while solder paste is available,
it’s a pity that it isn’t sold in much
smaller quantities – say 5g or 10g.
This would mean a lot less wastage.
By the way, when you buy solder paste, make sure you store it
in a refrigerator so you’ll at least
maintain its six-month working
life. And if you store it in a fridge
that is also used to store food (of
course!), place the syringe in an
air-tight container because both
the solder spheres and the flux
apparently give off toxic fumes.
Applying the paste
As mentioned earlier, largescale manufacturers use lasercut stencils and a squeegee
system to apply just the right
COPPER PADS
PC BOARD
APPLYING SOLDER PASTE USING A
STENCIL AND SQUEEGEE
SOLDER PASTE LEFT ON PADS
AFTER STENCIL IS REMOVED
THIN SOLDER PASTE
STRIPE OVER PADS
LOW COST ALTERNATIVE: MANUAL
APPLICATION OF SOLDER PASTE 'STRIPE'
Fig.5: for reflow soldering, largescale manufacturers apply solder
paste to the board pads using a
squeegee and a very thin stencil,
laser cut from the PC board CAD
file (top). This leaves the paste
neatly on the pads (centre) but
this is not feasible for enthusiasts.
Luckily for fine-pitch SMDs, a very
thin paste stripe (bottom) is almost
as good.
siliconchip.com.au
Above: a closeup view showing a thin ‘stripe’ of solder paste applied manually
to the pads for one side of a 100-lead LQFP device, with the tiny solder spheres
just visible. This stripe is a tad uneven in thickness – a little too thick near the
left end, and a little too thin towards the centre.
Below: closeup of the same board after the device had been reflow soldered
using a snack oven. Despite the 0.5mm lead pitch, there were no solder bridges.
soldering process - not easy to repair!
So the most important thing about
this manual approach to applying the
solder paste is to take your time and
care in making the stripe as even in
width as you can.
It’s easiest to do this with the board
under a magnifier lamp or even a
low-power stereo microscope with
illumination.
I’ve also found that a very thin and
narrow-tipped (about 1mm) spatula
seems to make it easier to apply and
even-up the paste stripe, although a
very narrow ‘applicator wheel’ (I made
one myself) was almost as good, and
easier than a fine brush.
Whatever you use, the main ingredient is time and patience – applying
solder paste is a bit like trying to
spread microscopic caviar evenly on
a sheet of glass.
In fact, since you have plenty of
paste, do a few dry runs on a sheet of
PCB copper laminate.
Placing the SMDs
form bridges between pads, during the
reflow soldering process.
However the secret of this approach
is to make the paste stripe very THIN –
only about 100mm wide or two solder
spheres thick.
If it’s no thicker than this, the result
is that surface tension and capillary
action causes the solder spheres to
‘pull themselves together’ into the
gaps between each SMD lead and its
board pad, when they melt during the
reflow soldering.
Most of the solder spheres in the
paste between the pads get sucked
into the molten solder directly under
each SMD lead, leaving very few to
form bridges.
Not too thick, not too thin
If you make the paste stripe too
siliconchip.com.au
thick, there WILL be enough spheres
left in the gaps between pads to form
bridges.
On the other hand, if you make the
stripe too thin, there will be insufficient spheres to pull together and
form a good bond between each SMD
lead and its pad underneath.
So erring in this direction results
in ‘missing joints’ after the reflow
Once the solder paste has been applied to the board, you can place your
fine-pitch SMD(s) in position, with
their leads over the board pads ready
for the reflow soldering process.
Large-scale manufacturers use a
pick and place machine to place all of
the components on the board in one
pass – not just the fine-pitch SMDs
but everything else as well. Then all
parts can be soldered to the board
in a single pass through the reflow
oven. But that’s not really feasible if
you’re placing all of the components
manually.
Our method is to place the fine-pitch
ICs on your board first, then do their
reflow soldering. After the board cools
down you can then inspect the results
and if all is well you can proceed to
solder in all of the rest of the components one by one, using the fine-tipped
soldering iron approach illustrated in
Figs.2 & 3.
You may be wondering how accu-
The business end of a ‘mini spatula’ made by the author for applying a stripe of
solder paste on pads for fine pitch SMDs. It’s shown here about 3x actual size.
March 2008 25
So depending on the location of
your fine-pitch SMDs on the board,
the reflow operation can easily result
in a ring of scorching on the underside
of the board. The result is a totally
unusable board and the SMDs won’t
be able to be salvaged either.
TEMPERATURE
(°C)
250
225
200
183
Get an old frypan
150
SNACK OVEN
TURNED OFF
AT 205°C
100
50
0
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
TIME
(M)
NOTES: SHADED PINK AREA SHOWS RECOMMENDED TEMPERATURE PROFILE LIMITS
183°C = MELTING POINT OF TIN-LEAD SOLDER (60/40)
225°C = RECOMMENDED PEAK REFLOW PACKAGE TEMPERATURE
BLACK CURVE = MEASURED TEMP PLOT OF BOARD & ICS
ON 220 x 140mm x 4mm THICK ALUMINIUM PLATE, HEATED INSIDE KAMBROOK
650W KOT-150 SNACK OVEN ('BAKE' SETTING, USING BOTH ELEMENTS)
Fig.6: The shaded pink area shows the reflow soldering temperature profile
limits recommended by SMD manufacturers. The solid black curve shows
the measured temperature plot achieved by the author using a low cost
snack oven on ‘BAKE’.
rately you have to place the fine-pitch
IC packages in position, before reflow
soldering.
The answer is placed FAIRLY accurately but not fanatically so. The
main thing is to make sure that every
device lead is over its corresponding
PC board pad, and closer to that pad
than it is to any other pads nearby.
If you achieve that, when the solder
spheres in the paste melt and coagulate during the reflow process, surface
tension and capillary forces in the
molten solder will automatically ‘pull’
all of the leads into position centrally
over their pads.
So the idea is to carefully lower the
IC package (orientated correctly, of
course) into position using a ‘vacuum
pickup tool’ or similar, and then nudge
it gently into the correct position using a fine jeweller’s screwdriver or
‘pick tool’.
Again, it’s easiest to do this under a
magnifier lamp or stereo microscope,
preferably one where you can rotate
the board and IC until you’re happy
that all leads are over their pads on
the board.
Once all of the fine-pitch SMDs have
been placed carefully in this way, your
26 Silicon Chip
board will be ready for reflow soldering. Be very careful not to bump or jar
it, because the SMDs could easily be
jolted out of position.
Reflow soldering
Now how do we do the actual reflow
soldering? If you use an online search
engine to track down info on reflow
soldering, you’ll find that quite a few
have tried doing it with an electric
frypan or skillet.
The basic idea is to place the PC
board in the centre of the frypan, applying power until the solder paste
clearly melts and flows under each
SMD lead, then turn off the power and
allow it all to cool down.
This can work – but there is a big
risk of scorching the underside of the
PC board; inevitably the underside
of the board must be raised to a temperature considerably higher than the
melting point of solder.
This board-overheating problem
tends to be made worse because the
heating element in the underside of
most frypans is circular in shape.
This produces uneven heating of the
PC board, with a cooler region in the
centre surrounded by a ‘ring of heat’.
If you decide to try the frypan approach, please don’t use a frypan that
is also used for cooking food.
The fumes given off by solder paste
during the reflow process are quite
toxic and are likely to be absorbed by
the frypan metalwork and/or Teflon
coating. So the toxins may well be
transferred into any food cooked in
the frypan afterwards.
Buy a cheap frypan specifically for
the job, and mark it clearly ‘NOT TO
BE USED FOR FOOD COOKING’.
Because of the toxic fumes given off
during reflow soldering, it’s also very
desirable to do it in a well-ventilated
area – preferably outdoors. This applies regardless of whether you use a
frypan or some other heating device.
Having read the references on the
web about reflow soldering using a
frypan, I decided to try it but with a
slightly different approach.
I bought a cheap frypan, then did a
few experiments with it. To try getting
around the board scorching problem,
I cut a ‘heat spreader’ plate from 4mm
thick aluminium sheet, and placed
this in the centre of the frypan with
my test board sitting on it.
This did seem to make the heating
fairly even but there was still a major
problem.
Even with the frypan’s thermostat
set for maximum, the temperature on
the top of the PC board never reached
the melting point of solder (183°C), let
alone the 215° level that is necessary
to ensure good reflow.
Presumably the small air gap between the bottom of the frypan and
my spreader plate added too much
thermal resistance. So I removed the
spreader plate and tried again, with
the board placed directly on the bottom of the frypan.
This time the temperature on the
top of the board did reach about 210°C
and reflow took place, but when it
all cooled down I discovered that
the underside of the board had been
scorched in a number of areas that
had been directly over the circular
heating element.
siliconchip.com.au
So reflow soldering with a frypan is
just not worth the risk.
Using a snack oven
Another el-cheapo reflow technique
that you’ll come across on the web
involves the use of a small electric
‘snack’ or toaster oven. Almost all of
these use a pair of heating elements,
one at the top of the oven compartment
and the other at the bottom.
Whatever you’re going to heat up
in the oven goes on a tray supported
by a wire mesh ‘drawer’ in the centre,
which is linked to the oven door so
it slides in or out when the door is
closed or opened.
Often there’s a switch which allows you to select either the top element (‘GRILL’) or the bottom element
(‘REHEAT’) or both at the same time
(‘BAKE’). Each element draws about
325 watts, so the oven uses about
650W when both are used together.
Since the reflow operation only involves drawing this power for five
or six minutes at most, this isn’t a
problem.
The main advantage of using this
kind of snack oven for reflow soldering
is that the heating is done by infrared
radiation, on the top of the board as
well as from below, just like a ‘proper’
IR reflow oven. The main difference is
that your board stays fixed in the oven
during the whole process, rather than
moving through different temperature
regions on a conveyor belt.
This means that you have to arrange
for the reflow temperature profile to
be provided in some other way. This
turns out to be easier than you would
think.
I decided to try the snack oven
approach for myself. So I bought
a Kambrook KOT-150 snack oven
which cost the magnificent sum of
$29.95. This has no thermostat, just
an electromechanical timer and the
element selector switch. But the lack
of a thermostat is not a problem and
the timer didn’t turn out to be all that
necessary either.
My first test with the snack oven
was to clamp a thermocouple temperature probe onto a test board, which
was then placed in the small pressed
tinplate tray that came with the oven.
The tray was then placed on the oven’s
sliding mesh drawer and the oven door
closed carefully so the thermocouple
lead could exit through a small gap at
the top of the door.
siliconchip.com.au
Here’s the setup we used successfully for reflow soldering of fine-pitch SMDs.
The board assembly is clamped on a 220 x 140mm plate of 4mm thick aluminium
plate, with a thermocouple probe clamped to the board copper near the 100-lead
device. Shortly after this shot was taken the snack oven was turned on, and then
turned off again as soon as the digital thermometer reading hit 205°C.
The oven was set to BAKE (both
elements on) and the timer knob set
to apply power for about 10 minutes.
I then proceeded to take temperature
measurements every 15 seconds.
The resulting temperature characteristic turned out to be very close to
the solid black curve in Fig.6, which
also shows (shaded pink area) the
reflow temperature profile limits for
fine-pitch SMD IC packages recommended by larger chip manufacturers
like NXP/Philips.
As you can see, the warm-up characteristic is nicely within the recommended limits. By turning off the
power to the snack oven when the
temperature on the top of the board
just reached 205°C, the board temperature coasted up nicely to a peak at 215°
As soon as the temperature coasted down to about 165°C, the door of the snack
oven was carefully swung down to allow the entry of more air to speed up the
cooling. Both of the SMDs on this board had been reflow soldered very nicely,
with no solder bridges between leads or pads. The board had not been damaged
in any way, either, so I can recommend the snack oven approach.
March 2008 27
and then began to coast down again. It
dropped down below the 183°C solder
melting point temperature about 6.5
minutes after switch-on, so after waiting about one more minute, I carefully
opened the door and drawer to allow
cooling to occur more rapidly.
When the test board had cooled
right down, I took it out of the tray and
checked underneath to see if there had
been any scorching. There was none
at all – even the silk screening on the
underside of the board showed no
discolouration.
Trial run
Thus encouraged, I decided to carry
out a reflow soldering test on another
PC board. This was prepared with solder paste stripes around the pads for a
fine-pitch IC and then an SMD device
was carefully placed over these pads.
Then I made my first mistake.
In an effort to make the process a
little more controlled, I drilled four
3mm holes in the oven’s tinplate tray,
so the board could be fastened into it
using four M3 machine screws and
nuts. One of the screws was also used
to attach the clamp for the thermocouple probe, to hold the probe securely
in position with its bead in contact
with the board’s top copper close to
the SMD chip.
The board and tray were carefully
It’s not elegant but it works: an SMD chip baking oven, made by the author
by converting a discarded blower heater. The reflector part of the heater was
flattened and bent into a small rectangular oven shape, then re-attached to the
front of the blower heater element (just visible through the opened front door).
placed on the oven’s mesh drawer and
the oven door gently closed so they
slid smoothly inside. Then power was
applied to the oven again, measuring
the top-of-board temperature every 15
seconds as before. All went well, with
exactly the same temperature profile
as before. But just as the temperature
reached about 200°C (just before I
would turn off the power) there was a
‘PING’ sound – apparently the tinplate
tray had been under stress as a result
of the board being bolted inside and
the stress was relieved suddenly when
the temperature reached 200°.
Having turned off the power as
soon as the temperature reached
205°, I waited impatiently while the
Ten Tips for successful DIY reflow soldering of SMDs
1. Store your solder paste in a sealed container in the fridge, to prolong its useful life.
2. Take care to apply the solder paste in a 'stripe' along the centre of the SMD lead pads on the PC board, with the stripe no
more than about 1.5mm wide and (most important) very thin – no more than about 100 m, or two solder spheres. As even
in thickness as you can make it, also – no lumps or voids...
3. Use a small snack oven for reflow soldering. Clamp the PC board on the top of a flat heat diffusion/support plate made
from 4mm thick aluminium sheet, say 220 x 140mm in size (to fit comfortably in the snack oven). Also monitor the
temperature on the top of the board near one of the SMDs, using a thermocouple probe connected to a digital thermometer.
4. Place the SMD chip(s) in position on the board carefully, with all leads as near as possible to their corresponding board
pad. You don't have to be fanatical about this though: the chips will auto-locate during reflow, providing each lead is closer
to its own correct pad than to the pads on either side.
5. Place the board and its support plate on the oven's slide-out drawer very carefully, so as not to bump or jolt the SMDs from
their positions. Then carefully close the oven door so they slide smoothly into the oven – again without jarring.
6. Use both the upper and lower heating elements of the oven for reflow solder heating. This is usually achieved by selecting
the BAKE setting. Using both elements gives more even heating, closer to that in a proper IR reflow oven.
7. Switch on the oven, monitoring the temperature on the top of board using the thermocouple probe and digital thermometer.
The temperature should rise fairly smoothly, reaching the melting point of tin/lead solder (183°C) in just under
five minutes. Take care not to bump or jar the oven after this.
8. As soon as the temperature reaches about 205°C, turn off the oven power without bumping anything. The temperature will
continue rising, to reach a peak at around 215-220°C. It should then begin falling again.
9. Wait until the temperature drops below the melting point of solder – say down to about 165°C. Then it should be safe to
open the oven door so the drawer and its contents slides out, to speed up further cooling.
10. When the board has cooled down to around room temperature, remove it from the support plate and check the solder
joints on all SMD leads with an illuminated magnifier or stereo microscope. If there are any solder bridges, these can be cut
away using the tip of a hobby knife or 'sucked' off using desoldering braid and a fine-tipped soldering iron.
28 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
temperature peaked again and crept
downwards once more. Once it had
dropped to about 165° I carefully
opened the door, so the drawer and
tray slid outwards.
Then I examined the SMD chip with
a magnifying glass, only to discover
that stress relief ‘ping’ at 200° had
caused the SMD chip to be jolted out
of position. The reflow soldering had
actually occurred quite nicely but with
the chip and its leads in the wrong
position. Bother!
However, the overall result still
confirmed that the snack oven was
quite suitable for reflow soldering.
So I decided to make a much sturdier
PC board support plate, to replace the
flimsy tinplate tray.
The new plate was a 220 x 140mm
rectangle of 4mm-thick aluminium
plate and had a 3mm hole drilled near
each corner, for the board hold-down
clamp screws.
The holes were countersunk underneath so countersink-head screws
could be used to hold down the board,
without producing bumps underneath
the plate. This was to make sure that
the plate and board could be slid
smoothly around on the oven’s mesh
drawer.
Another board was prepared with
solder paste and a fine-pitch SMD chip
placed carefully in position. Then the
board was clamped to the top of the
new support plate, the thermocouple
probe fitted and the complete assembly placed inside the oven.
This time everything went really
well. There were no ‘pings’, the solder reflowed nicely and when it all
cooled down again a board inspection
showed that the SMD chip had settled
itself in the correct position and was
nicely soldered. And there were no
solder bridges!
So we are able to report that reflow
soldering of fine-pitch SMD chips can
be done successfully using a low-cost
snack oven like the Kambrook KOT150 shown in the pictures.
Listed on the page opposite are the
ten important ‘rules of thumb’ when
it comes to using a snack oven for
successful reflow soldering of finepitch SMD chips. If you follow these
rules carefully, success is almost
guaranteed.
Finally, what about using a “fanforced” snack oven? Not a good idea!
That fan could easily blow the SMDs
SC
out of position.
siliconchip.com.au
Footnote: About MSL rating
If you’re going to be using reflow soldering for SMDs in plastic packages, you
should know a bit about the way these
devices are rated in terms of MSL or
‘moisture sensitivity level’.
Basically, it has been discovered that
SMDs in plastic packages have a tendency
to absorb moisture when they’re stored in
typical ‘shop floor’ or workshop conditions
for any significant period of time. The
degree of moisture absorption depends
on a variety of factors –- including the
size of the device package, the number of
leads and the relative humidity level in the
storage environment.
The problem is that when SMDs are
heated up during reflow soldering, this
absorbed moisture tends to turn into
steam, and build up sufficient pressure to
cause cracking and other damage inside
the package. It can easily damage the chip
inside and/or its bonding wires, even if
no cracks are visible on the outside of
the package.
To minimise the risk of this kind of
damage during reflow soldering, chip
manufacturers nowadays bake most
plastic-package SMDs (especially those
in fine-pitch packages) for many hours at
125°C in a very dry and inert atmosphere,
to drive out any moisture. Then they are
sealed in hermetic packaging (‘dry packs’),
and the idea is that they should be left in
this packaging until just before they’re
subjected to reflow soldering.
Now because this last-minute unpacking
isn’t practical even for big manufacturers
and in any case isn’t really necessary for
some devices, semiconductor industry
standards bodies like JEDEC (formerly the
Joint Electron Device Engineering Council)
have established a system whereby each
device is given a rating to show how
long it can be safely left out of its hermetic packaging in a typical 30°C/60%RH
workshop or factory environment, before
reflow soldering. There are eight of these
MSL rating levels, ranging from MSL 1 for
packages which are deemed impervious
to moisture up to MSL 6 for packages
which are very sensitive to moisture and
must be reflow soldered within no more
than six hours after being removed from
their dry packs.
You’ll find this MSL rating printed on
the dry packs of most SMD devices in
plastic packages and certainly for those
in fine-pitch packages (which are almost
always rated at MSL 2 or higher). Table
2 shows the significance of the various
MSL levels.
So what do you do if you want to reflow
solder an SMD with an MSL level of 2 or
higher, if you know has been out of its
hermetic packaging for longer than its
rated safe time? Or if it hasn’t been out
for that long, but subjected to very high
relative humidity?
The good news is that it can be restored
so it can be safely reflow soldered, by
baking for about 24 hours at a controlled
temperature of between 115-125°C. This
can be done in a small fan driven hot-air
oven, provided the device is placed in a
small metal box to ensure even heating.
The box should also have some small vents
to allow the escape of any moisture that is
released during the baking.
I made up a small baking oven by converting a fan-type room heater that had
been dumped at council cleanup time.
The fan motor, fan and heating element
were all in perfect working order, as was
its thermostat switch.
So all I had to do was remove these
components and convert the heater case
into a recirculating-air oven. Then the
‘works’ were re-installed and the thermostat tweaked to cycle the oven temperature
around 118°C, which produced a rough
but quite serviceable DIY baking oven for
plastic package SMDs.
JEDEC MOISTURE SENSITIVITY LEVEL (MSL) RATINGS
MSL rating
1
Safe exposure time at <= 30°C/60%RH before reflow soldering
Unlimited (non moisture sensitive)
2
1 year
2a
4 weeks
3
1 week (168 hours)
4
72 hours
5
48 hours
5a
24 hours
6
6 hours (extremely moisture sensitive)
March 2008 29
Want to control a really big DC motor? This circuit can
handle 12V or 24V DC motors at currents up to 40A.
12V-24V High-Current
Motor Speed Controller
This 12V or 24V high-current DC Motor Speed Controller is rated
at up to 40A (continuous) and is suitable for heavy-duty motor
applications. All control tasks are monitored by a microcontroller
and as a result, the list of features is extensive.
T
HIS COMPLETELY NEW speed
controller is based on a PIC16F88
microcontroller. This micro provides
all the fancy features such as battery monitoring, soft-start and speed
regulation. It also monitors the speed
setting potentiometer and drives a
4-digit display board which includes
two pushbuttons.
The 4-digit display board is optional
but we strongly recommend that you
build it, even if you only use it for
the initial set-up. It unlocks the full
features of the speed controller and
allows all settings to be adjusted. The
microcontroller will detect whether
30 Silicon Chip
the display board is connected and if
not, the speed controller will support
only the basic functions. In this simple mode, it will function as a simple
speed regulated controller with automatic soft-start and with the speed being directly controlled by a pot (VR1).
All the other settings will be the initial
defaults or as last set (with the display
board connected).
When connected, the 4-digit display
allows you to monitor the speed and
the input voltage (useful when running
from a battery). It also enables you to
navigate through the various menus
to adjust the settings.
The circuit can run from 12V or 24V
batteries and can drive motors (or resistive loads) up to 40A. Furthermore,
this is our first DC speed controller
(except for out train controllers) incorporating speed regulation under load.
In other words, a given motor speed is
maintained, regardless of whether the
motor is driving a heavy load or not.
Monitoring the back-EMF
In speed controllers which do not
have good speed regulation (ie, the vast
majority of designs), the more a motor
is loaded, the more it slows down. In
order to provide speed regulation, the
siliconchip.com.au
Pt.1: By MAURO GRASSI
circuit must monitor the back-EMF
of the motor, since this parameter is
directly proportional to its speed.
As a result, our new speed controller
monitors the back-EMF of the motor.
“Back-EMF” is the voltage generated
by any motor to oppose the current
through the windings. EMF stands for
“electromotive force” and is an obsolete term for voltage. Back-EMF is directly proportional to the motor speed
and so by monitoring this parameter,
we have a means of controlling and
maintaining the motor speed.
In practice, the main control loop
of the microcontroller tries to match
the speed of the motor (back-EMF) to
the speed set by the pot or recalled
from a preset memory. If the measured
speed is lower than the set speed, the
duty cycle of the pulse width modulation (PWM) signal used to drive the
power Mosfets that control the motor
is gradually increased. In other words,
siliconchip.com.au
if the speed tends to drop, more power
is fed to the motor and vice versa.
The frequency of the pulse width
modulation can be set from 488Hz to
7812Hz. This is a useful feature since
different motors will have different frequency responses, as well
as different resonant frequencies.
This is important to reduce the
audible buzzing from the pulse
width modulation, as these frequencies are well within the
range of hearing.
By now you’re probably wondering how the microcontroller
monitors the back-EMF of the motor, considering that the motor is
continuously driven with pulse-width
modulated DC. The answer is that the
micro periodically turns off the PWM
signal to the motor for just enough time
for the back-EMF to stabilise. This
“window” needs to be wide enough
to ensure that we are measuring backEMF and not the spike generated by
the last PWM pulse. On the other
hand, we don’t want the window so
wide that the maximum power to the
motor is significantly reduced or that
the motor noticeably slows.
The compromise value is that the
motor is monitored for 200ms every
7.4ms (ie, about 135 times a second),
as shown in the scope diagrams in
this article. As a result, the fact that
we do monitor the back-EMF around
135 times a second means that the
power applied to the motor is slightly
less than the theoretical maximum,
although this effect is negligible.
A low-battery alarm is also incorporated to warn when the battery level
drops below a preset value. This is
especially useful for applications like
electric wheelchairs.
There are also eight memory speed
settings. All settings are persistent,
meaning they are retained in nonvolatile memory.
Soft start
When the motor is switched off,
perhaps by an external switch in series
with one of its terminals, the voltage
at the drain of the Mosfets will be
0V (this is due to the voltage divider
used to scale the back-EMF voltage
to within the operating range of the
microcontroller). The microcontroller
converts this analog value to a digital
value using an on-board ADC (analogto-digital converter).
The firmware detects this 0V con-
Main Features
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Good speed regulation under
load
Automatic soft-start and fast
switch-off
Eight memory settings
4-digit 7-segment display
Variable frequency for pulse
width modulation (PWM)
Battery level meter
Low-battery alarm
Persistent settings & defaults
Rated up to 40A continuous
current
12-24V DC input voltage
dition and sets the duty cycle of the
PWM to 0%. This ensures that when
the motor is switched in, its speed will
increase gradually from the stationary
state to the desired speed setting.
Turn-on currents for motors can be
very high and it is desirable to reduce
these surge currents as much as possible. That is why the automatic softstart feature has been incorporated into
the firmware. It will ensure that the
motor is brought up to the set speed
gradually.
Fast switch-off feature
Another feature that has been incorporated into the firmware is the
so-called “Fast-off” feature. This
means that the duty cycle of the PW
modulation is set to 0% (turning off the
motor) whenever the selected speed
setting of the pot goes to 0%. Rather
than decreasing the speed gradually,
setting the pot to its lowest setting
turns the motor off immediately.
This design also incorporates our
extensive experience with previous
speed controllers featured in SILICON
CHIP. As a result, it uses four highcurrent Mosfets to do the switching
(pulse width modulation), uses very
wide tracks on the PC board and heavyduty (40A) terminal blocks to carry the
heavy currents.
User interface
Two pushbuttons on the display
board are used to navigate through
the menus, while the pot is used both
to vary the speed and to vary certain
settings.
March 2008 31
Parts List
1 PC board, code 09103081,
124mm x 118mm
2 heavy-duty PC-mount terminal
blocks (3-way) (Altronics P2053)
1 8-pin DIP IC socket
1 18-pin DIP IC socket
1 SPDT toggle switch (S1)
1 50A 5AG fuse (Jaycar SF1976)
1 60A 5AG fuseholder (Jaycar
SZ2065)
1 12-way pin header (Altronics
P-5502)
1 PC-mount mini piezo beeper
(Jaycar AB3459 or equivalent)
1 220mH inductor (L1) (Jaycar
LF1276 or equivalent)
1 10kW 16mm PC-mount linear
single-gang pot (VR1)
1 500W horizontal trimpot (VR2)
Semiconductors
1 PIC16F88-I/P microcontroller
programmed with 0910308A.hex
(IC1)
1 MC34063 switchmode DC-DC
converter (IC2)
1 BC327 PNP transistor (Q1)
3 BC337 NPN transistors (Q2-Q4)
4 IRF1405 N-channel Mosfets
(Q5-Q8) (Jaycar ZT2468)
1 1N4004 diode (D1)
1 1N5819 Schottky diode (D2)
2 MBR20100CT 20A diodes
(Jaycar ZR1039) OR
1 40EPF06PBF 40A ultra-fast
diode (Farnell 910-1560) (D3)
5 1N4745 16V 1W zener diodes
(ZD1-ZD5)
2 1N5364BG 33V 5W zener diodes
(ZD6-ZD7) (Farnell 955-8217)
1 3mm red LED (LED1)
Capacitors
1 2200mF 50V low-ESR electrolytic (Altronics R-6207)
The two pushbuttons are sensitive
to two types of presses, short and long.
A short press is of the order of half a
second or less while a long press is
one around one second.
To change a setting, a long press
is usually needed. This prevents
unwanted changes to the settings,
which are stored in EEPROM and thus
recalled at the next switch on.
Because of the capabilities offered
by the PIC microcontroller, we have
32 Silicon Chip
1 470mF 16V electrolytic
1 100mF 63V electrolytic
1 100mF 25V electrolytic
1 10mF 25V electrolytic
3 4.7mF 16V electrolytic
1 220nF 100V MKT polyester
1 100nF 100V MKT polyester
3 100nF monolithic
1 470pF ceramic
Resistors (0.25W, 1%)
2 33kW
1 100W
2 4.7kW
1 56W
1 3.6kW
1 22W 1W
6 1kW
4 15W
2 470W
3 1W
Display Board
1 PC board, code 09103082,
73mm x 58mm
1 200mm length 16-way rainbow
cable
1 12-way pin header (Altronics
P-5502)
2 12-way header plugs (Altronics
P-5482) (to terminate cable)
1 SPST PC-mount momentarycontact switch, yellow (Jaycar
SP0722; Altronics S-1097) (S2)
1 SPST PC-mount momentarycontact switch, red (Jaycar
SP0720; Altronics S-1095) (S3)
1 16-pin DIP IC socket (optional)
1 100nF monolithic capacitor
Semiconductors
1 74HC595 shift register (IC3)
4 BC337 NPN transistors (Q9-Q12)
4 7-segment common cathode
red LED displays (Jaycar
ZD1855; Altronics Z-0190 )
Resistors (0.25W, 1%)
4 470W
8 39W
been able to incorporate a large number of features into the firmware, as
described in the separate panel later
in this article.
Circuit description
The circuit for the speed controller
is shown in Fig.1. As noted previously,
it can work with 12V or 24V batteries
but has been optimised for operation
at 24V. Within the circuit itself, there
are two separate voltage rails: +5V for
the microcontroller and +16V for driving the gates of the Mosfets. Both are
derived from the +24V input supply.
The main input supply is filtered by
a 2200mF low ESR capacitor, to minimise high-voltage transients which
can be produced by the inductance
of the battery connecting leads. This
capacitor is absolutely vital to the
proper operation of the speed controller at high currents.
S1 is the power switch and diode
D1 protects the low-power part of
the circuit (IC1 & IC2) from reverse
polarity. A 22W 1W resistor, a 33V
5W zener diode (ZD7) and a 100mF
capacitor also protect the MC34063
IC from transients on the supply rail.
The filtered supply is then fed to
the MC34063 (IC2) which operates
in a standard step-down converter
configuration to provide the +5V rail.
Three 1W resistors between pins 6 & 7
are used to set the maximum switching current. The output voltage is set
by the voltage divider associated with
trimpot VR2.
Only about 200mA is ever drawn
from this supply and most of this is
used to drive the display.
IC1 is the heart of the circuit and
is the popular PIC16F88 microcontroller which incorporates a number
of peripheral functions. Of these, the
timers, hardware PWM (pulse width
modulation) and three ADC inputs
are used.
The three ADC inputs used are at
pins 1, 2 & 18. As these need to be
within the 0-5V range, voltage dividers
consisting of 33kW and 4.7kW resistors
are used to scale both the input voltage
rail (which could be as high as 29V)
and the back-EMF from the motor, to
be fed to the ADC inputs at pins 1 &
18. The ADCs convert the monitored
voltages to 10-bit values.
The +16V rail is used as the gate
drive supply for the Mosfets and is
derived from the 24V supply via a
1kW resistor and a 16V 1W zener
diode (ZD1). Bypassing of this rail
is particularly important and is accomplished using 100mF and 100nF
capacitors near ZD1 and adjacent to
the transistors Q1 & Q2.
If the battery supply is to be 12V,
the 1kW resistor feeding ZD1 should
be reduced to 100W. In this case, the
supply will actually be between 12V
and 14V (depending on the actual battery voltage); still enough to provide
adequate gate drive for the Mosfets and
siliconchip.com.au
siliconchip.com.au
March 2008 33
Fig.1: the circuit uses PIC16F88 microcontroller IC1 to provide PWM drive to power-Mosfets Q5-Q8 which in turn control the motor. The microcontroller also
monitors the back-EMF from the motor, to provide speed regulation. IC2 is a DC-DC switchmode converter and this provides a +5V rail to power IC1.
a
f
DISP 3
a
a
b
g
e
f
g
e
c
d
b
f
g
e
c
C
B
E
C
Q10
b
f
C
Q11
E
E
g
e
d
B
8x 39
a
c
d
Q9
DISP 4
b
c
d
B
C
Q12
16
Vdd
15
Qa
1
Qb
SRClr
2
Qc
3
Qd
IC3 Sck
4
Qe 74HC595 Rck
5
Qf
OE
6
Sin
Qg
7 Qh
Vss
8
100nF
10
+5V
11
12
13
10
9
8
7
6
5
14
4
B
11
12
2
3
470
E
470
Q9–Q12: BC337
470
470
B
E
SC
2008
CON2
1
(TO MAIN BOARD)
DISP 2
DISP 1
C
DC MOTOR SPEED CONTROLLER
S2
S3
DISPLAY BOARD
Fig.2: the display circuit interfaces to the microcontroller & uses a 74HC595 shift register (IC3) & transistors Q9Q12 to drive four 7-segment LED displays. Switches S2 & S3 are used to control the display & for software set-up.
ensure minimum heat dissipation (low
on-resistance).
The PWM output of the PIC16F88
(adjusted by firmware) appears at pin
6 and drives transistor Q3 which then
drives complementary transistors Q1
& Q2. Q1, Q2 & Q3 thus provide buffering and voltage level translation for
IC1’s PWM output to drive the gates
of Mosfets Q5-Q8 via 15W resistors.
Note that these resistors need to be
relatively low in value (ie, 15W) in
order to ensure quick charging and
discharging of the gate capacitances.
That’s because the gate capacitance
of these Mosfets can be quite high, of
the order of 5000-10,000pF each. If the
gate charging time is too long, the Mosfets will spend too much time between
the on and off states and this will lead
to much higher heat dissipation.
In fact, the gate voltage transitions
need to be very fast, of the order of 1ms
or less. This has been accomplished,
as shown by the oscilloscope screen
grab of Fig.4.
The specified Mosfets are from International Rectifier, type IRF1405. This
is a 55V 169A N-channel Hexfet with
an exceptionally low on-resistance
(Rds) of 5.3 milliohms (5.3mW) typical.
Their pulse current rating is a stupendous 680A.
The IRF1405 is specifically intended
for automotive use, in applications
such as electric power steering, anti34 Silicon Chip
lock braking systems (ABS), power
windows and so on and is therefore
ideal for this speed control application.
Why four Mosfets?
In fact, since the ratings of this
Mosfet are so high, you might think
that just one device on its own would
be enough to handle the 40A rating of
this speed controller project. So why
are we using four Mosfets in parallel?
As always, real world use brings us
down to earth. For a start, we are using
these Mosfets without heatsinks, apart
from the vestigial heatsink effect of
their being bolted to and connected to
the copper side of the PC board – not
much heatsink benefit there. Their
thermal characteristic is 62°C per watt
(junction to ambient), assuming that
are mounted in free air (which they
are not).
Assuming an ambient temperature
of 25°C and an on-resistance of 10mW
(conservative), we can approximate
the temperature of the Mosfets at
their highest operating current (10A
per Mosfet for a total of 40A). At 10A
and 10mW on-resistance, the power
dissipated is: 102 x .01 = 1W
This means that the temperature of
the case will be approximately: 25 +
62 x 1 = 87°C
This means that at full current, the
Mosfets will be very hot to the touch.
Careful: they will burn you. Our measurements produced a top temperature
of around 77°C after a test period of
half an hour.
In practice, even with much higher
ambient temperatures, the Mosfets
should not get quite this hot because
in “real world” operation, the speed
control is not likely to be providing
full power to the motor on a continuous basis. At 24V and 40A, the motor
would have 960W applied (ie, more
than 1HP) and this equates to relatively
high power operation.
Protection
Zener diodes ZD2-ZD5 are included
to protect the Mosfets from excessive
gate voltages. In normal circuit operation, these zener diodes do nothing.
Additional protection for the drains
of the paralleled Mosfets is provided
by 33V 5W zener diode ZD6, in parallel with a 100nF capacitor. The zener
is there to clip any residual voltage
transients which get past the 2200mF
low-ESR input filter capacitor.
The Mosfets are further protected by
fast-recovery diode D3 and its parallel
220nF capacitor. These parts are wired
across the motor terminals and are
used to suppress the high back-EMF
spikes caused by the armature inductance when the motor is switched off
by the Mosfets.
These components are crucial to
siliconchip.com.au
Fig.3: the yellow trace is the voltage waveform at the
drain of the Mosfets, when a motor is connected. There
are narrow spikes up to 31.7V when the Mosfets switch
off due to the inductance of the armature. The small
windows where the Mosfets are switched off to sense the
back-EMF of the motor can also be seen. The two vertical
cursors show that the period between such intervals is of
the order of 7.6ms. In other words, the speed of the motor
is monitored at 131Hz.
Fig.4: the yellow trace is the voltage waveform at the
drain of the Mosfets, while the purple trace is the gate
drive. The gate drive goes as high as 15.3V. The rise time
of the gates is 526ns while the fall time is 92ns. When
switching the Mosfets on and off, it is necessary that the
transition be fast, ideally under 1ms, otherwise the Mosfets
will dissipate more heat than is necessary. To ensure fast
switching of the Mosfets their gate capacitance needs to be
charged and discharged very quickly.
Fig.5: the yellow trace shows the voltage waveform at
the drain of the Mosfets when a motor is connected.
The irregular waveform corresponds to the back-EMF
monitoring. The Mosfets are then off and the voltage is
then directly proportional to the speed of the motor. The
window is narrow enough so that the motor’s deceleration
is negligible. Turning off the Mosfets to monitor the backEMF is asynchronous to the PWM driving the Mosfets.
Fig.6: the yellow trace is the voltage waveform at the
drain of the Mosfets and the purple trace is the waveform
at the gate of the Mosfets when a motor is connected.
Again, the irregular yellow waveform (arrowed)
corresponds to the period when the Mosfets are switched
off to sense the back-EMF and hence the speed of the
motor. You can see from the purple trace that the gate
drive during this time is 0V.
the operation of the speed controller.
Without them, the high voltages generated can and probably would destroy
the Mosfets.
Other protection measures
As already mentioned, diode D1
provides reverse polarity protection for microcontroller IC1 and the
switchmode supply (IC2). Zener diode
ZD1 is self-protecting in the case of
siliconchip.com.au
reverse supply connection. However,
if the supply is reversed, there will
be a heavy conduction path via fast
recovery diode D3 and the internal
substrate diodes in the four power
Mosfets. If you are lucky, the 50A fuse
will blow before the Mosfets are damaged but there is no guarantee of this.
SO DON’T REVERSE THE BATTERY
CONNECTIONS!
In a similar vein, if the outputs are
shorted while power is applied, high
current will flow through the Mosfets.
Again, if you are lucky, the 50A fuse
will blow before the Mosfets go up in
smoke. In reality, the 50A fuse is there
to stop a fire! SO DON’T SHORT THE
OUTPUTS TO THE MOTOR.
If the motor is under heavy load and
becomes stalled, high currents will
flow in its armature. Depending on
the motor’s rating, this may or may not
March 2008 35
This view shows the fully
assembled main board. The
assembly details are in next
month’s issue.
Fig.7: the yellow trace shows the voltage waveform at the drain
of the Mosfets, the purple trace shows the voltage waveform at
the gates and the cyan trace shows the voltage waveform at the
PWM output of the microcontroller. Note that transistors Q1-Q3
provide voltage translation by stepping up the 5V output from
the microcontroller to 12-16V. This higher voltage is needed to
ensure that the Mosfets are fully turned on.
blow the fuse. If the fuse does not blow
during stall conditions of the motor,
the Mosfets should survive although
they may get very hot.
Warning buzzer
If the circuit is overloaded, the
battery voltage should drop to the
point where the warning buzzer will
sound.
LED1 and its 470W current limiting
resistor are switched by a high level
on the output of pin 3 of the microcontroller. This is configured as a
simple digital output. It also turns on
Q4 and the piezo beeper. This output
is controlled by the firmware and can
be disabled.
A 1kW pull-up resistor is used on
pin 4 (reset) of the PIC16F88-I/P. This
ties the reset pin high which means
that the microcontroller is reset only
at power-on.
Finally, the rest of the outputs of
the microcontroller, namely pins 7-17,
are used to drive the optional display
board.
Display board
Fig.2 shows the optional display
board circuit. It connects to the main
board via 12-pin header CON1 and a
ribbon cable.
The display board consists of two
pushbuttons, four 7-segment displays
which are multiplexed by the firmware, four transistors and some resistors, as well as a 74HC595 shift register
(IC3).
Pins 1 & 2 of 12-way connector
CON2 supply +5V to the display board.
Pin 3 is connected to a digital input
The optional display
board is connected
to the main board
via a 12-way ribbon
cable. It displays
the motor speed as
a percentage of full
speed and is used for
the software set-up.
36 Silicon Chip
of the microcontroller and is pulled
high by a 1kW resistor on the main
board. Conversely, it is pulled low by
the display board. This is used by the
microcontroller to detect whether the
display board is connected or not.
Pins 4-7 of CON1 are used to drive
the transistors Q9-Q12 on the display
board. These transistors switch the
7-segment display cathodes.
Pins 8-10 of CON1 are respectively
the CLK, DATA and OUTPUT ENABLE
lines and these go to the 74HC595 shift
register (IC3). The microcontroller
drives these lines to load a new 8-bit
value into the shift register. The outputs of the shift register are connected
across the four 7-segment displays and
drive the anodes.
Finally, pins 11 & 12 are connected
to pushbuttons switches S2 & S3 on the
display board. They are also connected
to digital inputs on the microcontroller (which have internal pull-ups
enabled) and these inputs are used to
monitor the pushbuttons.
Next month, we will cover the
construction and troubleshooting of
the speed controller. In the meantime,
take a look at the “Software Features
& Set-up” panel on the facing page.
siliconchip.com.au
DC Motor Speed Controller:
Software Features & Set-up
T
HE STRUCTURE of the firmware
for the DC Motor Speed Controller is shown overleaf in Fig.8. The
transitions between the various
menus are made using the switches
on the display board and are indicated with labelled arrows.
There are four possible switch
presses, either Short or Long and
either the Left (L) or Right (R). Thus,
for example, “Short R” refers to a
short press of the right pushbutton.
Main menu
The Main menu is as shown in
Menu 1. It consists of the letter ‘P’
(for “percentage”) and three digits
with a decimal point indicating the
range 00.0% to 99.9%. The percentage value indicates the fraction of
full speed the motor is currently
running at.
In this mode, the motor’s speed
can be adjusted by varying the pot.
The letter ‘P’ will flash while the
motor’s speed increases or decreases
to the new setting. When the current
speed reaches the speed set by the
pot, the letter ‘P’ will stop flashing
and there will be a short beep (if
enabled).
Since there is a small periodic
window when the pulse width
modulation is turned off by the
firmware in order to read the backEMF, at full speed the reading will
not indicate 99.9% but will achieve
its maximum at around 98% or so.
Monitoring the input voltage
From the Main menu, press “Short
R” once and you will be taken to the
display shown in Menu 2. It consists
of a ‘b’ (for “battery”) followed by
three digits with a decimal point indicating a level from 00.0V to 99.9V,
to monitor the battery. For good
voltage accuracy, it is important that
the +5V supply rail be precisely set
using trimpot VR2.
In practice, with the supply rail
to the microcontroller set at 5V, the
level will not register any higher
than around 40.1V. This is because
the voltage divider used to derive
the voltage reading consists of 33kW
and 4.7W resistors. The relatively
high series resistance of 37.7kW was
chosen to avoid damaging the input
of IC1 if the input voltage goes any
higher than around 40V.
To go back to the Main menu, either press “Short L” or press “Long
R”. If you press “Long L”, you will
set the low-battery alarm level to
91.6% of the current voltage input
level (and then return to the Main
menu). This is a shorthand way to
set the low-battery alarm level when
you know that the batteries are fully
charged.
For a typical 12V battery, they are
fully charged at around 13.8V (with
charger connected) and should not
be discharged beyond 11V.
Press “Short R” to go to the lowbattery alarm level menu.
Setting the low-battery alarm
From the Main menu, press “Short
R” twice. You will be taken to the
low-battery alarm level menu as
shown in Menu 3.
It consists of an ‘A’ (for “alarm”)
followed by three digits which indicate a level between 00.0V and
41.6V. This will show the current
setting of the low-battery alarm or
rather, the voltage level below which
the alarm will sound (if enabled).
Whenever the input voltage is
below this level, the display will
flash (with increasing frequency as
the voltage drops) while if the alarm
sound is enabled, there will be a
flash from LED1 and a beep.
To set the low-battery alarm level
. . . continued next page
Looking for real performance?
NOT A REPRINT – Completely NEW projects – the result of
two years research & development
•
•
•
•
160 PAGES
23 CHAPTE
RS
Fr om th
e pu bli sh
Learn how engine management systems work
Build projects to control nitrous, fuel injection and turbo boost systems
Switch devices on and off on the basis of signal frequency, temperature and voltage
Build test instruments to check fuel injector duty cycle, fuel mixture and brake and
coolant temperatures
Mail order prices: Aust. $A22.50 (incl. GST & P&P); Overseas $A26.00 via airmail.
Order by phoning (02) 9939 3295 & quoting your credit card number; or fax the details
to (02) 9939 2648; or mail your order with cheque or credit card details to Silicon
Chip Publications, PO Box 139, Collaroy, NSW 2097.
siliconchip.com.au
er s of
Intellig
I SBN
9 780
95
$19.80 (inc
GST)
turbo tient
mer
095 852
294 - 4
8 52
29
46
NZ $22.00
(inc GST)
TURBO
& nitrou BOOST
s
fuel cont
rollers
How en
g
managemine
ent work
s
March 2008 37
DC Motor Speed Controller: Software
Features & Set-up . . . continued
press “Long L”. The ‘A’ will start
flashing and then the low-battery
alarm level can be modified by adjusting the pot setting. To turn the
alarm off completely, simply set the
level to 00.0V.
When you have reached the required level, simply press any button and the level will be recorded
(and stored in EEPROM). Then there
will be a beep (if enabled) and you
will be taken to the Main menu.
Note that the motor will be turned
off automatically when setting the
low-battery alarm level.
Setting the PWM frequency
From the Main menu, press “Short
R” three times. You will be taken
to the frequency menu as shown in
Menu 4.
This consists of an ‘F’ (for “frequency”) followed by three digits
with a decimal point indicating a
level between 0.48kHz and 7.81kHz.
This is the current PWM frequency.
As the frequency increases, the
resolution of the PWM setting decreases.
At 0.48kHz (actually 488Hz) the
resolution is 10 bits. This decreases
to six bits at 7812Hz. Thus, the resolution is at worst six bits or 64 levels
and at best 10 bits or 1024 levels.
While in this menu, press “Long
L” and you will be able to set the
frequency. The ‘F’ will start flashing
and then the frequency will be modified according to the pot setting.
When you have reached the required frequency, simply press any
button and the level will be recorded
and stored in EEPROM. Then there
will be a beep (if enabled) and you
will be taken to the Main menu.
Note that the motor will be automatically turned off when setting
the frequency.
Enabling & disabling
audible cues
From the Main menu, press “Long
L”. You will be taken to the settings menu as shown in Menu 8. It
consists of ‘A’ (for alarm) followed
by either ‘0’ or ‘1’ (0 = disable, 1 =
38 Silicon Chip
enable) and a ‘b’ (for beep) followed
again by either ‘0’ or ‘1’ (0 = disable,
1 = enable). In this menu, pressing
“Short L” will toggle the alarm setting (enable/disable) and pressing
“Short R” will toggle the beep setting
(enable/disable).
When the alarm setting is disabled,
there will be no beeping when the
input voltage falls below the alarm
level. There will still be a warning
flashing on the display, however.
To disable the latter, simply set the
alarm level to 00.0V. When the beep
setting is disabled, audible beeps
emitted by the firmware at certain
points (as when setting certain values or when the desired speed is
reached) will be blocked.
If you do not want any beeping
from the piezo buzzer, simply set
‘A’ to 0 and ‘b’ to 0. In this menu,
pressing “Long L” will take you to
the Reset Menu, as explained below.
Pressing “Long R” will take you back
to the Main menu.
Reset menu
From the Main menu, press “Long
L” twice. You will be taken to the
Reset Menu as shown in Menu 9.
It consists of the letters ‘CL’ (for
“clear”) followed by two digits and
a decimal point of the form X.X.
The X.X represents the current
version of the firmware, which
for this release stands at 3.0. It is
possible that future releases of the
firmware will add new features or
refinements to critical sections of
the code.
While in this menu, press “Short
L”, “Short R” or “Long R” to go back
to the Main menu.
Note, however, that pressing
“Long L” will reset all settings to
the default values and the speed
controller will lock until power is
turned off. When a power-on reset
next occurs, the default values for
the frequency, low-battery level
alarm and audible beeps will be
restored.
This feature is useful for initialising the firmware variables and for
making sure that you begin from a
known state. Most of the time, it will
not be used.
Memory speed mode
From the Main menu, press “Short
L” to enter memory mode. The display will be as shown in Menu 6.
It consists of the letter ‘C’ (for
“constant”) followed by a digit from
1-8 (indicating one of the eight available memories), in turn followed by
two dashes.
Now adjusting the pot will select
one of the eight memories. When
the pot becomes stable for a short
period, the speed of the motor will
be set according to the current value
of that memory.
The display will change as shown
in Menu 7. This display still consists
of the letter ‘C’ followed by the number of the memory but it will then
have a decimal point followed by
two digits representing the speed
percentage from 00% to 99% (the
first two letters will flash until the
set speed is reached).
Adjusting the pot will now change
the selected memory and the speed
setting will be recalled from one
of the eight stored memory speed
settings (after a short beep, if enabled).
To go back to normal mode, where
the motor speed is controlled directly by the pot, simply press any
key, long or short.
Setting the memory
To set one of the eight memory
speed values you press “Long R”
from the Main menu. The display
will change as shown in Menu 5. It
consists of the letter ‘C’ (for “constant”) followed by a digit from 1-8
(indicating one of eight memory
settings) and two dashes.
Now adjusting the pot will select
one of the eight memory settings to
store the current value of the speed
of the motor.
When the pot becomes stable for
a short period, the speed of the motor will be stored at that particular
memory. This can be recalled later
by entering memory mode, as explained in the previous section.
There will be a short beep (if enabled), indicating that the value has
been stored and you will be taken
SC
back to the Main menu.
siliconchip.com.au
siliconchip.com.au
HALT STATE.
TURN POWER
OFF AND
BACK ON TO
RECALL DEFAULT
SETTINGS.
LONG L)
MENU 9: LAST TWO DIGITS SHOW
THE FIRMWARE VERSION. PRESS
LONG L TO RESET ALL SETTINGS
TO DEFAULT VALUES.
(PRESS
(PRESS
SHORT
L)
(INACTIVE OR
ACTIVE POT)
(PRESS ANY
KEY OR
INACTIVE
POT)
(SET
FREQUENCY
WITH
POT AND
PRESS ANY
KEY TO
(PRESS
RETURN
LONG L)
TO MAIN
MENU)
(SET ALARM
LEVEL WITH
POT AND
PRESS ANY
KEY TO
RETURN
(PRESS
TO MAIN LONG L)
MENU)
MENU 5: SET MEMORY MENU. CHANGE MEMORY
NUMBER BY VARYING POT. ONE OF EIGHT
MEMORY PLACES CAN BE CHOSEN. CURRENT
SPEED IS STORED IN THE CHOSEN MEMORY.
(PRESS
LONG R)
SCREEN SHOWING THE LOW BATTERY WARNING.
IT SPELLS “Lo” FOR LOW BATTERY.
MENU 7: SHOWS THE MEMORY NUMBER
CURRENTLY RECALLED AND THE CURRENT
SPEED AS A 2-DIGIT PERCENTAGE.
MENU 6: RECALL MEMORY
MENU. CHANGE MEMORY
NUMBER BY VARYING POT.
THE STORED SPEED WILL
BE RECALLED.
(PRESS
ANY
KEY)
(PRESS
SHORT
R)
(PRESS
SHORT
R)
(PRESS
SHORT
R)
MENU 4: CURRENT FREQUENCY
IS SHOWN IN KILOHERTZ.
MENU 3: CURRENT ALARM LEVEL IS
SHOWN IN VOLTS.
(PRESS ANY
KEY EXCEPT
LONG L TO
RETURN
TO MAIN
MENU)
(PRESS
LONG
R OR
SHORT
L)
MENU 2: INPUT VOLTAGE
IS SHOWN. USEFUL FOR
MONITORING BATTERY
(PRESS LONG L TO
LEVEL.
SET ALARM LEVEL* )
(PRESS
LONG
R OR
SHORT
L)
Fig.8: this diagram shows the structure of the firmware for the DC Motor Speed Controller. The transitions between the various menus are made using the
switches on the display board and are indicated with labelled arrows.
(PRESS ANY
KEY EXCEPT
LONG L TO
RETURN
TO MAIN
MENU)
(PRESS
LONG L)
MENU 8: DISABLE OR ENABLE
AUDIBLE CUES. 0=DISABLED,
(PRESS
1=ENABLED. A=ALARM,
LONG L)
B=GENERAL BEEP. PRESS SHORT
L OR R TO TOGGLE SETTINGS.
(PRESS
LONG R)
MENU 1: MAIN MENU. SPEED SHOWN AS
THREE DIGIT PERCENTAGE.
VARY SPEED WITH POT.
* ALARM LEVEL IS SET TO 91.6% OF CURRENT
INPUT VOLTAGE.
March 2008 39
SERVICEMAN'S LOG
Foxing out a Foxtel installation
Fixing TV reception problems in units
can be a real problem, especially if other
technicians have been involved and you
don’t know what they’ve done. It also
doesn’t help if you’re told that the fault is in
equipment that doesn’t even exist.
I recently received a handwritten
work order from the managing agents
of a block of 12 units, stating that the
antenna amplifier in the basement
needed urgent replacement. According to the order, it was ruining all the
Foxtel reception.
Now I had never been to this address
before and knew nothing about it. I
tried phoning the agents but the man
in charge wasn’t available. In the end,
40 Silicon Chip
I decided that as I had been contracted
to do the job, I might as well see what
I could do.
When I arrived, I discovered that the
block was a security building to which
I had no access except to the basement.
Inside, I could find no sign at all of a
distribution amplifier, nor any trace
of one ever having being there. There
was, however, a Foxtel amplifier.
The distribution amplifier was probably up in the roof (which would make
more sense), so I drove to the manag-
Items Covered This Month
•
•
•
•
•
•
Foxtel satellite system
TCL TFW76BO3 76cm widescreen CRT TV
Toshiba 42WP48A plasma TV
TCL L32M61A7 LCD TV set
Dell Latitude D600 notebook
computer
Ford Falcon XE electrical
problems
ing agent and obtained the key. Back
at the units, I finally got into the roof
area but there was no amplifier there
either. There was, however, ample
evidence to show that there used to be
one because there was an empty box
for one and there were cable fittings
for one to be installed. Fortunately, I
managed to talk to a long-time resident
of the block who was pretty cluey and
he told me that there used to be an amplifier there but it had been removed
many years ago.
He also told me that what was now
in place at the units was a Foxtel Satellite System that had been installed
privately except for the dish and LNB
which had been fitted by Foxtel. It
had been running successfully for a
few years but had failed about two
months earlier and several previous
technicians had called but had failed
to fix the problem.
Now the story I had previously been
given had a certain ring of truth about
it, as it is not uncommon for a distribution amplifier to interfere with Foxtel
transmissions. That’s because most
technicians invariably run free-to-air
transmissions and Foxtel on the same
line through this amplifier. A faulty DC
power supply can thus introduce hum
bars into the distribution amplifier
and severely affect the Foxtel signal,
sometimes to the extent that it prevents
the decoder from working at all.
siliconchip.com.au
However, in this instance, there was
no distribution amplifier and unfortunately, I am not all that familiar with
the Foxtel satellite system. For starters, I don’t know the satellite channel
plan or what sort of levels to expect,
nor do I have the correct signal level
measuring equipment.
Fortunately, I managed to borrow
the correct meter from a colleague
although I wasn’t initially all that confident as to how to drive it. However,
having familiarised myself with the
gear, I checked the signal level output
from the Foxtel amplifier to be 75dB,
which is not enough for a 12-outlet
building. As a result, I picked up a new
Foxtel satellite amplifier (identical to
the original unit) from my wholesaler,
along with a generic spare and an 18V
power supply.
I connected the brand new Foxtel
amplifier, only to find it was DOA
(dead on arrival) – faulty straight out
of the box! I then fitted the new generic
amplifier and set its output for 100dB.
That done, I went to one customer’s
unit and measured 70dB at his outlet
which is perfect for Foxtel. But there
was still no Foxtel.
Foxtel use horizontal and vertical
polarisation in their systems, controlled by the power supply, ie, 12V
= vertical and 18V = horizontal. The
question was, which one was being
used? I tried the 18V power supply I
had with me but no go, so I went back
to my friendly wholesaler and picked
up a 12V power supply. It made no
difference so I left the original 18V
power supply in place.
Foxtel also uses two local oscillator
siliconchip.com.au
frequencies – 11.3GHz and 10.7GHz
– to match the appropriate LNB, so
that was the next thing to look at.
I managed to get the locked Foxtel
security code (set-up menu 0611) to
get into the service menu and changed
the local oscillator from 11.3GHz to
10.7GHz.
At last – perfect pictures! It was then
just a matter of going around to all the
other Foxtel owners and readjusting
their menus in the same way.
When the job was completed (all in
the same day), I had time to reflect on
what had probably happened. When
the original fault occurred, there was
a lot of miscommunication as to what
the problem was and too many different technicians got involved.
The cause was actually the Foxtel
amplifier but a previous technician
had changed the LNB on the dish
for one with a different local oscillator frequency and didn’t replace the
original when he found it made it
worse – probably because he was told
to just change it and didn’t have time
to check the result.
TCL widescreen TV
Tim O’Brian (not his real name) has
a TCL TFW76BO3 76cm widescreen
CRT TV which is about 18 months old.
Unfortunately, it was now cutting off
after just a few minutes of operation.
TCL (Thomson China Ltd) is the
largest manufacturer of TV sets in the
world and also makes sets for many
other brands such as NEC, etc. TCL is
their own brand name and the sets are
sold with a 3-year warranty. And so,
as the local service agent, off I went
Ozitronics
Tel: (03) 9896 1823 Fax: (03) 9011 6220
Email: sales2008<at>ozitronics.com
Introducing the MT System
A series of C programmable chips based on the
latest generation of 8051, Atmel AVR or ARM
core flash microcontrollers.
Onboard 16-bit run-time interpreter
for fast program development
Multiple, selectable program storage
Lots of sample programs
Free IDE includes text editor, compiler, simulator, test
terminal & serial downloader (no programmer required)
Demoboards available for quick and easy project
development
Prices & documentation available on website:
www.ozitronics.com
:
to Tim’s address at unit 23/123 Mary
St to do an in-home warranty repair.
I was not familiar with Mary St,
which turned out to be a very long
street with a lot of home units. Anyway, I soon found number 123 but I
couldn’t find unit 23 (the units were
very poorly labelled). I phoned Tim on
the mobile and spoke to his mother,
whose English was not too good, and
explained my predicament.
Unfortunately, our communications
weren’t the best so I asked her to come
outside and look out for me or at least
describe some kind of landmark. Even
so, I still couldn’t find her or the unit,
so I queried the street address and
nearest cross street.
She kept telling me “unit 23/123
Mary St” but the nearest cross street
she nominated was nowhere to be
seen. In the end, I got back into the
car and cruised up and down until
I reached the cross street but I still
couldn’t find 123.
It took a long time, interspersed with
March 2008 41
Serviceman’s Log – continued
some fairly terse phone calls, to work
out what was happening. It turned out
that the street address was actually
1-3 (1 to 3) and its entrance was in the
cross street. Once that had been sorted
out, I had to negotiate the full-security
lift which required a card to operate it
before I was finally let into Tim’s place
on the third floor.
When I saw the set, I knew that
this was just going to be “one of those
days”. It was, of course, situated in
an entertainment centre in the corner
with pitiful access. What’s more, the
set weighed more than I do – which
is a lot these days!
On the plus side, the fault just might
have been due to another symptom I
hadn’t been told about, namely retrace
lines on the screen.
My first step was to remove the back
and swing it around while dodging
both the baby and the dog who were
trying to eat my tools. I then carefully
readjusted the flyback transformer
screen control until there were no
more lines and waited 15 minutes to
see if the set switched off. It didn’t and
I then managed to put the back on the
TV and replace it in the entertainment
cabinet without leaving either the baby
or the dog inside.
After completing the necessary
42 Silicon Chip
paperwork, I left, confident that the
repair had been completed satisfactorily. But of course, that wasn’t to be the
end of it. A few days later, Tim phoned
back and said that while it was now
taking longer, the set was still cutting
out. Drat!
There was nothing for it but to go
back to “123”.
This time, I went armed with a new
flyback transformer and a video output
IC (TDA6107AJF/N1) which isn’t even
shown on the circuit diagram (it just
shows discrete transistors). Fortunately, I didn’t get lost this time and
even better, the baby and dog were in
other rooms.
Anyway, I removed the chassis,
replaced both items and checked
and resoldered a few possible dry
joints. That done, I adjusted both the
horizontal and vertical focus pots and
the screen controls very slowly and
deliberately.
After an hour or so, I was finally
finished and was demonstrating the
set when it went off all by itself. I was
ropeable and completely bamboozled
by the whole turn of events.
Now I couldn’t even switch the
set back on and prior to it going off, I
couldn’t change the stations with the
remote control. Fortunately, yours
truly had caused the problem and there
was a simple solution. I had brought
along a spare service remote control to
help with the adjustments and it was
in an open carrier bag into which I had
just put my University multimeter.
The heavy multimeter was pressing
against the remote control’s pushbuttons, causing the random results I was
experiencing!
Aaaarghh!! After a job like that, you
need a stiff drink and a lie down!
Toshiba plasma TV
I was recently called to a Toshiba
42WP48A plasma set that had been in
heavy-duty use at a club. The barman
had phoned to say it was dead and
asked if I could fix it straight away because of the sport. I asked him if there
was any clue beforehand that the set
was about to fail and he replied that
there was absolutely nothing.
Apparently it had been working one
minute and was “dead” the next.
When I called, I could see that there
was no power and so the set had to go
to the workshop. Back at the ranch, I
took the back off and a few quick measurements showed that the power supply – a Sanken PKG-4000 PDC20360
– was dead.
I have seen a few of these power
supplies before and have sometimes
found the white wirewound resistors
to be faulty for no apparent reason.
There is no circuit for the power supply as it is considered unrepairable.
The PC board is mounted on a sheet
of aluminium using over 30 screws
and 12 plastic mounting clips to hold
it in place.
In this case, R26 (10W 5W) was
open circuit so I replaced it. However,
when I switched the set on, it was
still dead.
It was then that I noticed that IC1
and R32 (1.5W) had blown so badly
that I couldn’t read what the device
type numbers were. The IC was obviously part of the standby power supply, judging by the size of the chopper
transformer – probably one of those
8-pin Mosfet and control ICs.
That was as far as I was allowed to
go. The club then told me the set had
actually been killed during a thunderstorm (great – now they tell me!)
Anyway, a new power supply was
ordered and the $900 repair charged
to the insurance company.
If the service manual had shown
more detail on the power supply, the
repair would have cost much less
than that.
TCL warranty job
I had a brand new TCL L32M61A7
LCD TV come in under warranty with
intermittent no sound when hot.
I thought that this would be a
straightforward repair. However, after
fooling around for some time with
vibration tests, I finally nailed the
problem by applying freezer to the
main microprocessor.
This large-scale surface-mount IC is
not designed to be replaced and so a
new main board had to be ordered to
fix the problem.
Dell notebook
I was recently asked to repair a
friend’s Dell Latitude D600 notebook.
His problem was that the computer
would not run from the battery, nor
would it even charge the battery.
A quick check of the BIOS indicated
that there was provision for two batsiliconchip.com.au
teries but only one was installed. After checking to see
that the machine’s existing 11.1V Li-Ion battery wasn’t
on the factory recall list, I decided to get a new one on
eBay. I also ordered a new 7.2V CMOS backup battery for
good measure.
When these new batteries were installed, not a lot had
changed. The computer continued to run correctly from
the PA-12 +19.5V AC adaptor but not from either the new
battery or the old battery. The BIOS (which I upgraded
to ver. A16 from A8) still reported two batteries and that
one was charging but the old battery always measured 0V
while substituting the new one gave an indication of 74%
charged. Neither value changed at any time.
Obviously there was something fishy about the battery
charging system within the computer but was it a hardware
problem or a software problem?
The main battery has a 9-pin connector. Pins 1 & 2 are
the +11.1V rail, while pins 6, 8 & 9 are the negative rail.
Pins 3, 4 & 5 measured +5V and pin 7 measured +3.26V.
I downloaded the service manual from the web and
stripped the notebook right down to just the motherboard
to see if I could find anything wrong. I then examined and
measured the voltages around the power supply very carefully but I couldn’t find any clues. There were no blown
fuses, burnt resistors or even hot components – all looked
perfect. Most of the charging is controlled via surfacemounted switching ICs.
I didn’t have the user’s guide but I did discover the
5-green LED charge gauge which confirmed that there
was no charge in either battery, despite what the BIOS
displayed. I then trawled the web but could find nothing,
so I went to the Dell website and asked for help via email,
quoting my service tag number.
I really wasn’t expecting very much but I was subsequently very pleasantly surprised when a gorgeous chick
phoned me up and told me they would send a technician
round the very next day to change the motherboard.
I was still very cynical, expecting some monstrous
catch, but lo and behold, a technician did rock up the next
day and replaced the motherboard under warranty – all
done in a tenth of the time it took me to dismantle the
notebook in the first place. Not only that, it was all free
and under warranty.
The new battery still would not work even though the
BIOS said it was 74% charged. However, the original
completely discharged battery now did work and really
started to charge, continuing to do so until it was at 100%.
Furthermore, it ran the notebook quite satisfactorily.
My friend was delighted and both of us were mightily
impressed with Dell’s customer service. They have really
put the meaning back into those oft-misused words.
So why does the BIOS indicate two batteries? Well,
there’s provision to install a second main battery in the
space that’s normally reserved for a floppy disk drive. As
for the new battery, I sent it back for a refund.
Falcon electrical problems
Finally, here is an interesting story concerning some
strange electrical faults in an old XE Ford Falcon. It was
sent in by R. S. of Hoppers Crossing, Victoria and I’ll let
him tell it in his own words:
An acquaintance’s youngest son, Brett, requested my
assistance to solve some electrical problems that he was
siliconchip.com.au
CIRCUIT
!
W
E
N
WIZARD
A revolutionary new system
that combines circuit design,
PCB design, simulation &
CAD/ CAM in one complete
package for your pc.
rom:
f
o
m
e
d
e
a fre oncepts.com
d
a
o
l
n
w
o
D
ave-c
w
w
e
n
.
w
ww
ions click on
s between
difference
To see the
ional vers
d & Profess
‘features’.
Standar
IDEAL FOR
Schools, TAFEs, Hobbyists & Business
Circuit Wizard Standard – $202*
&
Circuit Wizard Pro – $390*post*incin GST
Aust.
555Electronics
Australia and
New Zealand –
for orders or more
information,
please contact
19 Kensington St, Clovelly Park,
SA 5042 Tel (08) 8277 8936
email: bwigley<at>senet.com.au
www.555electronics.com.au
experiencing with his aging XE Falcon sedan (late 1984
model). This vehicle had originally been purchased new
by his late grandfather, so its service history was well
known.
The were several symptoms that concerned Brett. First
of all, the speedometer tended to react to the flashing of
the turn indicator, which was very strange indeed. In
addition, the righthand indicator lamp was permanently
illuminated, unless the indicator switch was set to activate
the righthand blinkers. And when the righthand blinkers
were activated, the indicator lamp turned off when the
front and rear globes illuminated.
Another strange fault was that the temperature gauge
swung from the low end of the scale to the high end in
a most alarming manner. This was so bad that Brett had
disconnected the sender wire in the engine bay to prevent
possible damage to the gauge.
Another problem was that the air-conditioning (a/c)
fan was intermittent, as was the a/c compressor clutch
which only worked if the fan worked. This problem had
been apparent for some time but had not previously been
investigated. It was open to conjecture as to whether it
was related to the other problems.
Due to rain, it was great day to work indoors and so I
suggested that we meet at his parent’s house, where the
garage/workshop has a pit – useful should it be necessary
to work underneath the vehicle. In my opinion, a pit is
more of a requirement than an ensuite when designing
and building a house!
Anyway, we examined the circuit diagram in the workshop manual and soon determined that the vehicle was
March 2008 43
Serviceman’s Log – continued
a base Falcon which had been fitted
with air-conditioning on the production line. At this stage, I was favouring
an earthing problem as the common
cause of all the symptoms. As a result,
I tracked down a common earth point
on the diagram for all the dashboard
wiring.
According to the manual, it was
located on the lefthand side of the
vehicle. This was eventually found
after removing the glovebox and a kick
panel and appeared to be in good order.
Furthermore, a quick check with a
DMM found just a millivolt or so across
the connection when everything was
powered up.
Brett then advised me that turning
on the headlights (either low or high
beam but not the parking lights) would
cause the fan to operate. This really
was strange. He had also noticed that
there was a single clicking sound just
before the fan began to rotate.
Brett also advised me that “hitting”
the car reasonably firmly in the vicinity of the click would also activate the
fan. And that in turn led us to a plug-in
44 Silicon Chip
30A relay. This relay is used to control
the fan and I suspected that it might
have an intermittent fault.
The relay was pulled from its socket
and its coil resistance checked. This
turned out to be about 87W which is
normal. The relay was then checked
by connecting it to a 12V DC supply
and this showed that the relay was
operating correctly.
In addition, its normally open (NO)
contacts had almost no resistance
when closed.
My next step was to bridge the
matching NO connections in the socket and this showed that the fan was in
perfect working order on the full speed
setting. However, it did not function on
the low or medium-speed settings and
I suspected a faulty high-wattage series
resistor as one was indicated on the
diagram. I wasn’t too concerned about
this at this stage, though – finding and
testing the resistor could wait until the
intermittent electrical problem had
been solved.
I went back to the circuit diagram
and traced the wiring to the relay coil.
This led me to a separate diagram relating to the a/c control which showed
that the feed was directly from the
switched side of the ignition switch.
More precisely, it came from a connection on the high side of the fuse
safeguarding the supply lead
to the fan.
Checking the coil
control voltage gave me
my first real clue to the
problem. It ranged
from 3V to a maximum of 10V. No
wonder the relay
wasn’t operating
correctly!
Next, I reinserted the relay as
it had passed all the
necessary tests. It was then that
I happened to lightly touch the thermal overload breaker that serves the
headlight circuit and, for a fraction of
a second, the fan roared into life.
The headlight’s thermal interrupter
unit is located towards the bottom of
the fuse block. However, the fuse block
shown in the diagram was different to
that fitted to the vehicle. I took another
look at the diagrams we had discarded
and found that the more upmarket
models (Fairmont, etc) were fitted
with the fuse block I was looking at
in this vehicle.
This also showed that the control
signal for the relay came from the
low side of a 20A fuse labelled ‘acc’,
just to the left of the thermal overload
breaker. Touching this fuse very lightly
immediately brought the fan to life.
I felt around the back of the fuse
block and moved the connecting wire,
to see if it was loose. It wasn’t loose
but the slightest movement caused the
fan to run so I removed the fuse and
found that it was intermittently going
open circuit.
Carefully dismantling this 3AG fuse
showed that the soldered connection
between the fuse element and the end
cap was the problem. I replaced the
fuse with a new one and no amount
of wiggling, tapping, banging or activation of the headlight switch would
cause the fan relay to switch off.
What’s more, with the engine running,
the a/c compressor clutch now worked
reliably as well.
I was also surprised to find that the
low and medium-speed fan settings
also now worked. So by replacing just
one fuse, I had fixed the intermittent
siliconchip.com.au
fan and a/c operation problems and the lower fan speed
problems as well.
Indicator problems
That left the righthand indicator lamp problem. It was
still lighting when the control was in the middle of its
travel (ie, neither the right nor left indicator selected).
So was there a problem with the control switch unit?
There are three connector blocks associated with the
electrical controls on the steering column, so I disconnected them all. Re-connecting the ignition/power circuit
then caused the fault to reappear. That meant that the
indicator selector, the high/low beam circuit, the horn
circuit and their switches were OK.
There was nothing for it now but to remove the instrument module. That done, I probed the flying socket
for voltage on the connection serving the repeater light.
This showed that the connection was at 0V with the
indicators in the off position, which is correct.
Moving the indicator to the righthand position then
showed a pulsing 0-12V DC voltage at this point, at the
frequency of the flash rate (about one pulse per second).
Again this was correct and Brett advised that he had also
checked this but double-checking never hurts.
That meant that the problem with the indicator lamp
was in the instrument cluster itself. Undoing six screws
gave us access to the circuit board which was now closely
inspected. We didn’t have a circuit diagram for the board,
so I began to trace the now-tarnished copper tracks from
the plug pins to the repeater globe, then through the globe
and on towards the base of the temperature gauge. As
mentioned, this gauge had been indicating a problem,
so it was somehow connected to the fault.
I went back to the plug and observed that a nearby
copper track had been very hot in the recent past. To
get a better view, I undid the three screws that secured
the economy gauge to the circuit board (this economy
gauge is simply a mechanical vacuum gauge sensing the
air pressure in the inlet manifold). Once this gauge was
out, I could now see that this track had become detached
from the board surface due to the excess localised heat.
A closer examination revealed four or five small black
marks (about the diameter of a pin), which had been
hidden behind the vacuum gauge mounting point. What
had caused these? The answer came when I looked at
the back of the vacuum gauge mounting.
This showed that two flat-headed screws had vibrated
loose and were now capable of touching two adjacent
copper tracks on the PC board. These screws were both
threaded into the brass block of the vacuum gauge,
thereby forming a complete current path between the
two tracks and shorting them out
The fix was simple. First the two screws were retightened and, for insurance, sealed in position with a drop
of nail polish (a beautiful shade of pink). The floating
track was then removed and the break bridged using a
short length of tinned copper wire.
And that fixed all the remaining problems. The indicator lamp now operated correctly and both the speedo and
temperature gauge remained steady, with no tendency to
flick in sympathy with the indicator signal. After that, it
was just a matter of reassembling the instrument panel
and the old Ford was ready for the road once more. SC
siliconchip.com.au
Now available:
THE
5
5
DC POWER FOR CRITICAL COMMERCIAL
AND INDUSTRIAL APPLICATIONS
Hospital theatre backup
Portable medical instruments
Portable computers & cameras
Mining tools
Oceanographic instrumentation
Remote area power
Railway signalling
Rolling stock
Aviation
Military Systems
Ph: 61 89 302 5444
or order on line <at>
www.siomar.com
March 2008 45
PICAXE VSM:
It’s Time to PLAY!
In the third part of our PICAXE VSM tutorials Clive Seager
talks us through using some of the ‘virtual instrumentation’
included with the software – from a simple voltmeter to an
advanced I2C protocol debugger!
A
fter you have designed a circuit using PICAXE VSM,
you will naturally want to test it! Fortunately VSM
has a wide range of ‘virtual instruments’ available
for testing purposes. This article assumes you have worked
through the tutorials in parts 1 and 2 of this series, so are
familiar with drawing circuits in the VSM software.
Voltmeter and Ammeter
Voltage and current can be measured in two separate
ways. As an example, open the ‘high command.dsn’ sample file from the /samples/picaxe/commands folder. You
will then need to use the ‘File>Save As’ menu to save
with a different filename so you can experiment and save
modifications to it.
Fig.1 shows the circuit with a traditional voltmeter connected across the LED. When run, the voltmeter will show
the voltage when the LED switches on and off.
An ammeter can be added by deleting the wire between the resistor and PICAXE pin. Right click and select
Place>Virtual Instrument>DC Ammeter. Once dropped,
right click on the ammeter symbol and edit the properties
‘Display Range’ from amps to milliamps. Then draw the
Fig.2: virtual ammeter
added to the circuit.
Remember to change to
mA range!
two wires back in as shown in Fig.2.
When run you will now have a display of both current
and voltage. If you change any of the other component
properties – eg, (changing the ‘Forward Voltage’ of the LED
from 2V to 2.5V or the resistor from 330W to 270W) you
will see corresponding changes in the current.
The second, slightly simpler way of measuring voltage
and current is to just add probes onto any component pin
or wire. To do this, right click, select place and then either
the voltage or current probes (see Fig.3). Once the simulation is run, the probes will show the current or voltage at
the probe position.
Oscilloscope
Fig.1: simple LED circuit
with voltmeter attached.
46 Silicon Chip
On occasions you may wish to trace the voltage or a
signal over a period of time. This is when the virtual oscilloscope is of use
Open the ‘infrain.command dsn’ sample file and re-save
with a different filename. This uses a ‘simulated’ IR LED
and IR receiver (eg, equivalent to the TSOP4840). Two
siliconchip.com.au
Fig.3: right-click the mouse to add voltage and current
probes.
Fig:6: serial terminal demonstration.
channels of the oscilloscope are connected across the LED
output and the receiver output.
When run, the oscilloscope display panel will appear
on screen, showing the trace from the two channels. As
can be seen from Fig.5 the top LED trace clearly shows
the modulating signal, while the receiver trace shows the
demodulated inverted output! The virtual oscilloscope
includes all controls that you would expect to find on a
real device, and so the position, timebase etc can all be
adjusted as you require.
Serial Terminal
This time take a look at the ‘sertxd command.dsn’ sample
file. This demonstrates the ‘Virtual Terminal’ which acts as
an RS232 serial terminal for testing programs with serial
data. When run, the serial data output from the PICAXE
chip is displayed on screen within the terminal window.
As with all serial systems, you do need to set the baud
rate and polarity of the terminal to match the PICAXE settings (4800,n,8,1 [inverted polarity] in this case). This is
carried out by right-clicking on the terminal symbol and
selecting ‘Edit Properties’.
COMPIM
While we are talking about serial communication it
is also worth mentioning the COMPIM (COM Physical
Interface Model). This ‘symbol’ acts as a link between the
Fig.4: two PICAXE chips communicating via a simulated
infrared link.
Fig.5: virtual oscilloscope trace.
siliconchip.com.au
Fig.7: remember to set the serial baud rate and other
parameters, or you will see corrupt characters on screen!
March 2008 47
simulator and the real serial port of the computer. This,
amazingly, allows connection of real serial devices to a
simulated PICAXE chip!
As an example you could connect a serial GPS module
to the serial port of the computer and then have the simulated PICAXE chip parse the NMEA serial data stream!
The ‘COMPIM demo.dsn’ file demonstrates the COMPIM
feature.
Signal Generator
The Signal Generator is demonstrated via the ‘count
command.dsn’ file. When this simulation is run the Signal
Generator control panel is displayed on screen. First make
sure the generator is outputting a square wave (sawtooth,
triangular and sine are also available) of around 5V and
then try adjusting the frequency. The change in frequency
should result in a different ‘count command’ value displayed on the serial terminal.
An alternate, simpler, way of applying test signals to
a wire is to just drop a generator probe onto the wire (as
Fig.10: I2C debugger analysing data written to a 24LC16B
EEPROM
but fortunately the technicalities of the protocols are taken
care of automatically in the PICAXE system, via use, as an
example, of the writei2c and readi2c commands.
Those interested in studying these protocols further may
be interested in the function of the I2C and spi debugger
instruments. For instance, the writei2c command.dsn’ file
demonstrates how the ‘I2C debugger’ instrument is connected to the I2C bus.
When the simulation is run the details of each I2C
transaction – start signal (S), address (AO), data pulses,
ack pulses (A), nack pulses (N), stop signals (P) etc – are
clearly listed in sequence on screen. This makes it an in-
Fig.8: demonstration of the COMPIM feature.
with the voltage and current probes). This is carried out
by right-clicking and selecting Place>Generator.
SPI and I2C debuggers
SPI and I2C are two different communication protocols
used to link ICs together. The protocols are quite complex
Fig.11: I2C debugger trace. This shows the time, and type,
of all activity on the I2C bus
valuable learning tool for those interested in understanding
these protocols.
Summary
Fig.9: virtual signal generator.
48 Silicon Chip
The software also contains a few other instruments such
as a logic analyser – have a play with them! Using ‘virtual
simulated’ instruments will never be quite the same experience as twiddling dials on real-life bench-top models but
using these simulations is still a worthwhile process.
PICAXE VSM incorporates an impressive array of virtual
instruments – and you certainly wouldn’t be able to buy
a new oscilloscope, signal generator or I2C debugger for
anything like the price of a VSM licence!
SC
siliconchip.com.au
MARCH
PRE - CATALOGUE
Kits for Kids
Motorcycle Construction Kit
Learn about mechanical &
electrical construction
principles while building your
own electric-powered
motorcycle. Everything's
included, even tools to put it
all together. The instructions
Cat. KJ-8900
are excellent, with colour photos
and a detailed parts list.
$12.95
• 187 piece kit
• Suitable for ages 10+ (contains small parts)
• Measures: 210(L) x 147(W) x 56(H)mm
301 Piece Solar Construction Kit
Build a solar-powered motorcycle, a front-end
loader or whatever else your imagination can come
up with. All parts, fasteners and tools are included
as well as an illustrated instruction booklet with
colour photos and a
comprehensive
Cat. KJ-8905
parts list.
• Tools included
$29.95
• Motor and solar
panel included
• Requires 1 x AA battery
• 10yrs+
153 Experiments in Electricity and
Magnetism Kit
Learn all the basic
principles behind
electricity.
Cat. KJ-8835
153 different
$39.95
experiments
require only a 9V battery
or no power at all.
• Ages 9+.
• 9V battery: SB-2423
$699
2.4GHz Baby Monitor with LCD
Screen & IR Colour Camera
Set up your own weather channel or connect to
your computer for storage and analysis. The indoor
receiver measures the indoor temperature,
humidity, atmospheric pressure and
receives weather data from the
outdoor thermometer-transmitter
sensor, wind sensor, and rain gauge.
The receiver unit has USB interface
output allowing data to be uploaded
to a PC or laptop and a AV
output so you can view
the weather data on
your TV.
Was $299
This popular 2.4GHz wireless surveillance system
has a specially designed indoor Hi-res colour
CMOS camera and hand-held LCD monitor, that
enables you to monitor your home, children or
elderly residents even when it gets dark. You can
link the monitor to a VCR to record what the
camera captures or link it to a TV that has the
'Picture-in-Picture' feature to keep an eye on the
baby while you watch your favourite TV show.
• 2.4 inch colour TFT-LCD screen
• Can work with up to 4 cameras
Cat. QC-3258
• 10 IR LED illuminator
$199
• Hi-Res colour CMOS camera
• 4 channel selection
• Low power consumption
• 2 x PSU included
• Monitor measures 65(L) x110(H)x
23(W)mm
SAVE
$100
NEW
Watch high definition digital TV on your desktop or
laptop PC for the same cost as a standard definition
set-top box. Simple to set up and use, just connect
the USB stick, plug in the antenna, install the
software and away you go.
• Supports worldwide
free-to-air DTV
• Software with time shifting
and scheduled recording
• Compatible with Windows XP, ME and Vista
• Windows only - not suitable for Mac Cat. XC-4859
• Antenna, cable and software included
$99
NEW
This wireless video system simply
splices into the car's reversing light
cable. It is automatically activated
when you select reverse and gives
you a clear view behind your vehicle.
The camera is waterproof and can be
mounted outside the vehicle.
• Specifications:
• 2.4" wireless colour LCD screen
• Colour CMOS camera
• 110° Camera viewing angle
250GB H
INCLUD DD
ED
Weather Station with Wireless
Sensors, Computer Interface & TV Out
Reversing Camera Kit with Wireless Camera
TELEPHONE> 1800 022 888
Cat. QV-3085
USB Digital TV Stick
NEW
FOR INFORMATION AND ORDERING
SAVE
$250
$199
Mains Adaptor 12VAC 2A
Unregulated, 7 plugs
included.
• Approval number:
N17582
$29.95
The DVR is fitted with a 250GB hard drive,
can accommodate up to 4 cameras with
power derived from the DVR and will allow
you to record and view up to 4 cameras
simultaneously. Package includes the DVR
with 1 dome and 1 outdoor IR camera with
bracket, mounting hardware,
power supply, 14m of cable,
software, USB interface lead
and user manual. Additional
cameras sold separately.
Was $949
Cat. XC-0332
Mains Adaptor 12VAC 2A
Unregulated
Cat. MP-3057
DVR Camera Kit
Preven
Drivewat
Acciden y
ts
200W PA Combo Amp/Speaker
A PA system in a box. 3 channels with
balanced and unbalanced inputs, RCA inputs
for an auxiliary source. The ideal small PA for
schools, sports organisations, churches,
weddings, conferences or solo acts.
• 12" speaker
• 2 channel equaliser
• Line level RCA inputs
• Tough moulded
enclosure
• Balanced and
unbalanced line outs
• 200WRMS power
output
• Dimensions: 600(H) x
410(W) x 325(D)mm
NEW
Cat. CS-2517
$399
Cat. QC-3725
$249
Better. More Technical
INTERNET> www.jaycar.com.au
Rear view
1
Wireless Weather Stations
38 Channel 1.5W UHF
Pocket Transceiver
Be Your Own Weatherman
This high-quality light-weight
UHF transceiver is ideal for
use in many professional and
leisure activities.
• 1.5W output
• Up to 8km range
• Hi/lo power setting
Weather Station with Wireless Sensors and Doorbell
Anyone with a interest in the weather will
love this station. It has an unbeatable range
of features, it is great value, and best of all
has no need for messy wiring. The system
measures and displays inside and outside
temperature, air pressure, rainfall, humidity,
wind speed, direction, and chill factor.
• Requires 7 x AA batteries Cat. XC-0293
• Indoor
$149
display unit
140(W) x
170(H) x
40(D)mm
Cat. DC-1040
$59
Dynamo Powered Splash
Proof Radio with LED Torch
Compact, portable, splash proof. 90 seconds
winding gives 20 minutes operation. Has
provision for battery operation if desired.
Was $34.95
Cat. AR-1775
$28.95
SAVE
$6
SAVE
$5
RC Solar Pond Pump
Uses latest solar
technology ,
SAVE
requires no
$15
wiring, can be
used a night and
no running costs.
Turns on/off via
remote control.
• Squirts 50mm
high
• 2 bright LEDs
• 350mm (Dia.)
Was $69.95
Cat. YH-5452
$54.95
Mini Digital Camera Keyring
Always have a camera with you!
• 100k pixels
• Takes up to 80 photos
(20 Hi-Res)
• Use as a web cam
• Includes easy-to-use
software & cable
Was $19.95
Cat. QC-3190
$14.95
2
Children's Weather Station
Observe, learn and forecast the weather. This fully functional weather
station is designed especially for children.
Cat. XC-0308
• Shows wind direction
$39.95
• Measures wind speed in kph & mph
• Indicates relative humidity
SAVE
• Measures temperature in
$10
Fahrenheit & Celsius degrees
• Measures rainfall in inches & centimetres
• No batteries required
Suitable for children 8yrs+ Was $49.95
Mini Head Torch
3 Super Bright LEDs
Professional Grade
Outdoor Garden Lighting
Quality Die Cast low voltage outdoor garden lighting range.
Each fitting is die cast, powder coated and moisture sealed
with neoprene gaskets. The spectacular range
can be powered by 12 volt halogen lamps or a
professional 24V for large installations where
OFF EACH
voltage drops would normally be a problem.
Garden Flood Light
• Size (length including spike) 310mm.
• Dia. at globe 75mm.
Cat. SL-2770 Was $14.95 Now $13.45
Focal Spotlight/Highlighter
• Length: 320mm approx
• Dia at globe: 65mm.
Cat. SL-2772 Was $14.95 Now $13.45
General Purpose Spotlight / Highlighter
• Size 100(H) x 96(dia) mm excluding bracket and spike.
Cat. SL-2774 Was $14.95 Now $13.45
Wall Mount Step Light
This light will mount on a wall, and is
ideal for lighting a path, or steps.
• Size 100(dia) x 50(D)mm.
Cat. SL-2778 Was $9.95 Now $8.95
Pathway Illuminator
A stylish contemporary design used to reveal a
pathway at night.
• Size 170(H)mm excluding spike which is 160(L)mm
• Dia 60mm.
Cat. SL-2780 Was $16.95 Now $15.25
Flushmount Illumination
This lamp is designed to be embedded into a path
or walkway. It can actually be walked on.
• Size 100(H) x 96(Dia)mm.
Cat. SL-2776 Was $14.95 Now $13.45
Pagoda Light
• Size 300(H)mm excluding spike
• Dia 140mm.
Cat. SL-2784 Was $19.95 Now $17.95
10%
Dynamo Wind up LED Torch
Great gift idea for campers or
hikers. Just one
minute of
winding will
give you 30
minutes of
light.
Approximately
Cat. ST-3337
130mm long.
Was $19.95
$14.95
Easy to install - no wires, no fuss. Displays full clock and
calendar functions, humidity, temperature
readings, barometric changes as well as an
SAVE
audio and visual indication when the doorbell
$20
is pressed. Can be desk or wall mounted.
• Indoor display 225(W) x 260(H) Cat. XC-0336
x 27(D)mm
$79.95
Was $99.95
SAVE
$5
Excellent for outdoor activities.
• Requires 2 x AAA batteries
• Weatherproof and digitally
controlled
• Brightness levels 100% &
50%
• 3 super bright LEDs Cat. ST-3280
• Flashing mode for
$14.95
emergencies.
Was $19.95
Mini Head Torch with 6 Super Cat. ST-3282
Bright LEDs also available
$14.95
Was $19.95
Better. More Technical
SAVE
$5
Jumbo Display Indoor/Outdoor
Thermometer with Memory
This thermometer has one
LCD that shows both the
inside and outside
temperatures
simultaneously. It will record
the minimum and maximum
temperatures that are
reached. The outside
temperature sensor is
waterproof and is on 3
metres of very thin cable, which helps when
putting through a window seal. Has a tilting bail
for standing as well as a screw hole for wall
mounting.
• Reads both °F/° C, selectable with switch
• Measuring range: -39.9°C to 49.9°C
• -39.8°F to 122°F
• Size: 110(H) x 100(W) x 22(D)mm
SAVE
• Operates with AAA battery (supplied)
$7
Was $35
Cat. QM-7205
$28
7 LED Diving Torch
This torch is waterproof
to 30m, and is very
light and small. It
features 7 high
brightness Japanese
made white
LEDs. There is a
rubber hand grip and rubber head
which incorporates the rotary on/off
switch, as well as a lanyard.
Was $19.95
SAVE
$5
LED Safety Band
SAVE
$5
Cat. ST-3076
$14.95
Traffic and other hazards can see you coming
from afar.
• Four red LEDs
• Adjustable
30mm wide
Velcro band
SAVE
$5
• Flashing or steady lighting mode
• Visible up to around 300m Cat. ST-3026
Was $9.95
$4.95
FOR INFORMATION AND ORDERING
TELEPHONE> 1800 022 888
INTERNET> www.jaycar.com.au
Speakers
Economy Car Alarm
Wide range of speakers
available for a multitude
of home or car audio
projects
HOME AUDIO
6" Polycone Woofer
• Nom impedance: 8 ohms
• Power handling: 30WRMS
Was $24.95
SAVE
$5
Cat. CW-2108
$19.95
8" (200mm) Paper Cone
Woofer
• Nom impedance 8 ohms
• Power handling 30WRMS
Was $24.95
10" (250mm) Paper
Cone Woofer
• Nom impedance 8 ohms
• Power Handling 40WRMS
Was $29.95
An economy alarm that has many of the
advanced features you would normally only
expect to find on more expensive systems.
Fantastic value.
• Includes
• Electronic black box controller
• Shock sensor
• Ignition cutout relay
• Wiring
looms
Was $89
SAVE
$5
SAVE
$5
Cat. CW-2110
$19.95
Cat. CW-2119
$24.95
6.5" Driver
Is capable of astounding bass extension.
It will deliver incredibly deep bass that matches
bigger sized woofers in a good enclosure design.
Suitable for Hi-Fi or home theatre applications.
• Nominal impedance: 8 ohms
• Power handling: 60WRMS
• Sensitivity: 85dB 2.83V at 1m
SAVE
$10
Cat. LA-9000
$79
MP3 Player Cassette Adaptor
Lets you play your favourite
MP3 tracks on any
car cassette
player. Excellent
sound quality!
• Built-in 3.7V
250mAh
battery
SAVE
• Supports
$20
SD, mini
SD and MMC cards
Was $69.95
Cat. AR-1764
$49.95
DIY Kits
Cat. CW-2154
Ref: High Performance Electronic Projects for
Cars - Silicon Chip Publications.
$89.95
CAR AUDIO
4" Kevlar/Dome Tweeter
Coaxial Car Speakers
NEW
New and improved! These Kevlar® cones are
now paired with soft dome tweeters that provide
cleaner and crisp sounds while maintaining
natural and smooth balance. The 12dB octave
crossover are now integrated into the speaker.
• Nominal impedance: 4 ohms
• Power handling capacity: 40WRMS
• Dimensions: A 102 B 90 C 47
Cat. CS-2370
$79.95
7" TFT Touch Screen VGA
Monitor
Not only will you be
amazed at the high
resolution and audio
clarity of this unit, but
the added feature of
touch screen
capabilities
enables use
with a
laptop/PCs ,
games consoles and
endless other VGA
operate devices.
Was $499
Cat. QM-3749
$449
SAVE
$50
Speedo Corrector MkII
When you modify your
gearbox, diff ratio or
change to a large
circumference
tyre, it may result in
an inaccurate
speedometer. This kit alters the speedometer signal
up or down from 0% to 99% of the original signal.
With this improved model, the input setup selection
can be automatically selected and it also features an
LED indicator to show when the input signal is
being received. Kit supplied with PC
with overlay and all electronic
Cat. KC-5435
components with clear English
$49.95
instructions.
Economy Adjustable
Temperature Switch
If you don’t need the display, or the huge
operational range of the High Range
Adjustable
Temperature Switch
with LCD, then this
unit is a great
alternative. It has an
adjustable
switching
temperature up to 245°C, and it can be configured
to trigger with rising or falling temperature. It has
adjustable hysteresis (the difference between
on/off temp) which is a great feature many other
units do not possess. It can be used to operate
cooling fans on a radiator or amplifier, over-temp
warning lights or alarms, and much more. The
small temperature sensor reacts quickly to temp
changes. Kit supplied with PCB,
Cat. KC-5381
NTC Thermistor, & all electronic
$29.95
components.
FOR INFORMATION AND ORDERING
TELEPHONE> 1800 022 888
INTERNET> www.jaycar.com.au
Auto Savings
2 Farad Capacitor
with Coloured LED Display
Cat. RU-6751
Was $149.00 Now $129.00
Save $20.00
1 Farad Capacitor
with coloured LED Display
Cat. RU-6752
RU-6752
Was $99.95 Now $89.95
Save $10.00
Digital Tachometer
Cat. QM-1448
Was $69.95 Now $59.95
Save $10.00
Alcohol Breath Tester Key Chain
Cat. QM-7293
Was $39.95 Now $29.95
Save $10.00
QM-1448
iPod® Car Charger
Cat. MB-3650
Was $19.95 Now $14.95
Save $5.00
Auto Current Tester
Cat. QP-2251
Was $29.95 Now $24.95 Save $5.00
Car Voltage Meter/In-Out Thermometer/Clock
Cat. XC-0116
Was $39.95 Now $29.95 Save $10.00
Car Voltage Meter with Clock & Stopwatch
Cat. XC-0118
Was $34.95 Now $24.95
Save $10.00
XC-0118
LED Globes for Vehicles
Ideal replacements for your vehicles incandescent
lamps. • 12 volt
Note: Only suitable for show or off road use.
19 x White for car stop/tail lamp
ZD-0311
19 x Red for car stop/tail lamp
ZD-0316
19 x Yellow for car indicators
ZD-0317
19 x White for car indicators
ZD-0319
19 x Red for car tail (bayonette) lamp ZD-0318
Cat. ZD-0311
$19.95
Cat. ZD-0316
$14.95
Cat. ZD-0317
Cat. ZD-0319
$19.95
Cat. ZD-0318
$9.95
$14.95
120A Auto Circuit Breakers
These circuit breakers feature a 3 digit LED
voltage display so you can keep an eye on the
battery's condition, a status LED which will
illuminate only when there is a complete
connection. High quality screw down connections.
SZ-6002
Accepts:
1 x 0 gauge in
1 x 0 gauge out.
Power Handling: 120 Amps
Dimensions: 45(H) x 100(W) x 45(D)mm
Was $39.95
Cat. SZ-6002
$34.95
$5
OFF
SZ-6004
Accepts:
1 x 4 gauge in
2 x 8 gauge out
Power Handling: 2 x 60 Amps
Dimensions: 45(H) x100(W) x
70(D)mm
Cat. SZ-6004
Was $44.95
$39.95
Better. More Technical
$5
OFF
3
Dome & Ribbon Tweeters - Home Audio
Dome Tweeters
Cat. CT-2005
These tweeters offer great versatility and
cater for just about any application. They
feature ferrofluid injection cooling which
increases power handling and greatly
reduces failure to high thermal transients.
Three models available
• CT-2005 19mm Shielded Dome Tweeter
• CT-2007 25mm Titanium Dome Tweeter
• CT-2009 25mm High Performance Dome
Tweeter
Speaker Surround Kits
8” Speaker Surround Kit CF-2791 $19.95
• 2 x 8 inch rubber surrounds
• 10ml bottle of special glue
10” Speaker Surround Kit CF-2792 $29.95
• 2 x 10 inch rubber surrounds
• 10ml bottle of special glue
12” Speaker Surround Kit CF-2793 $39.95
• 2 x 12 inch rubber surrounds
• 10ml bottle of special glue
FROM
$19.95
Cat. CT-2007
$24.95
Cat. CT-2009
$34.95
Loudspeaker Design
Cookbook Sixth Edition
Response Ribbon Tweeter
The sixth edition
of this world
famous
loudspeaker
design "Bible" as
used by
manufacturers
and amateurs
alike! Totally
updated and
revised chapters,
significantly
more chapter
footnote
references and explanatory
graphs. Includes new
tutorials on woofer design,
curvilinear vents, a brand
new chapter on transmission line
enclosures, CAD software, in car sound
and 2 fully documented speaker designs.
Will teach you all you need to know to
design, construct and test loudspeakers for
your home stereo, home theatre and car.
• 233 pages
Cat. BA-1400
• Softcover
Was $69.95
$49.95
Ribbon tweeters are renowned for their
smooth, natural response. Fast transient
response, neodymium magnet, Cat. CT-2032
Kapton voice coil.
• Nominal impedance: 6 ohms $49.95
• Power handling: 10 WRMS
• Sensitivity: 92 dB 283mV <at> 1m
• Recommended crossover
frequency: >2500Hz
Universal Crossover PC Boards
Build Your Own Crossovers
These 2 and 3 way crossover
printed circuit boards have
been designed as a versatile
method of building your own
customised crossover that will suit
just about any speaker system. They can be used on 4 or
8 ohm speakers, and even with a combination of both.
They can be wired to give a max. of 12dB per octave, or
by leaving some components out, they could be 6dB or a
combination of both. Full instructions on how to select the
various components for different crossover frequencies
are included, as well as an
2 Way CX-2605 3 Way CX-2606
attenuation table for tweeters.
$17.50
SAVE
$20
$13.95
2 x 100 WRMS Stereo Amplifier
with Remote Control
This is a good looking, no-nonsense stereo
amplifier that is
rated at a
generous 100
watts RMS
per channel
and will form
the heart of an impressive stereo system.
• Inputs for Mic, Tape, Tuner,
Cat. AA-0470
AV1, AV2, CD, Phono
• Approx 420mm wide
$199
Passive Direct Injection Box
One of the most
useful and versatile
audio tools available,
this DI Box is
indispensable in
providing easy
interfacing and
connection between a
variety of audio equipment in
Cat. AA-0402
numerous applications.
$19.95
• Perfect for all live sound, permanent
installations - club, church and practice PA
systems, monitor systems, home and project
recording studios, karaoke and DJ sound systems.
• Rugged, roadworthy, all-steel construction will
give years of continuous reliability.
Five Way Speaker Switch
Allows up to five pairs
of stereo speakers
to be connected
to any Hi-Fi
system. Each pair
of speakers cay be
individually turned on or off in any
combination. Also features a separate
headphone socket.
4
$19.95
NEW
Speaker Stand
These speaker stands are made of
tough, steel construction, featuring
three strong tubular supports and can
be filled with dry sand and/or lead shot
with a suitable sealant applied to the
base to prevent leakage. Produce a
cleaner, more lively sound from your
existing speakers.
• Dimensions:
• Base Plate - 280(D) x 210(W)mm
• Speaker Plate - 210(D) x 170(W)mm Cat. CW-2846
• Height: 400mm
$99
• Black in colour • Sold as a pair
Kits
Theremin Synthesiser Kit
The Theremin is a
Cat. KC-5295
weird musical
$59.95
instrument that was
invented early last century
but is still used today. The
Beach Boys classic hit
"Good Vibrations"
featured a Theremin.
By moving your hand
between the antenna
and the metal plate, you
create strange sound effects like in those scary
movies. Kit includes a machined, silk screened, and
pre-drilled case, circuit board, all electronic
components and clear English instructions.
Three Stage FM Transmitter
This is a Three-Stage radio transmitter that is so
stable you could use it as your personal radio
station and broadcast all over you house. Great for
experiments in audio transmission. It includes a
microphone but you can transmit other material as
well. Includes a mic, PCB with
Cat. KJ-8750
overlay and all other parts.
$19.95
• Requires 9V battery
Cat. AC-1643
$29.95
Better. More Technical
Build Your Own Speakers
Essential for multi driver speaker systems
2 WAY SPEAKER CROSSOVERS
3500Hz/6dB
3500Hz/12dB
5000Hz/6dB
Cat. CX-2614
Cat. CX-2612
Cat. CX-2613
$10.50
$16.95
$10.50
3 WAY SPEAKER CROSSOVERS
800-5000Hz 6dB
700-53500Hz 12dB
1200-5000Hz 12dB
Cat. CX-2615
Cat. CX-2618
Cat. CX-2621
$16.50
$34.95
$57.50
Accessories to finish off your Speakers
SPEAKER EQUIPMENT FITTINGS
Speaker Cabinet SpikesCat. HS-8002
$10.95
• Pack of 4 for 1 speaker box only
Strap Handle
Cat. HS-8022
$4.95
• Rubber strap is reinforced with steel
• Total length 255mm x 27mm
Cabinet Handle
Cat. HS-8010
$9.95
• Dimensions 165(W) x 210(L)mm
Metal Cabinet Handles
• Recessed handle, rubber grip & spring return
Silver
Cat. HS-8015 $13.95ea
Black
Cat. HS-8016 $13.95ea
Flared Speaker Box
Cat. CX-2688
$4.95
• Flared to minimise air turbulence
Angled Sub-woofer
Cat. CX-2685
$14.95
• Angled at 30° to use in confined spaces
Grey Speaker Carpet Cat. CF-2757
$19.95
• Size 1m x 1.4m x 2mm
Black Speaker Carpet Cat. CF-2755
$34.75
• Size 1m x 1.8m x 3mm
Spray-on Contact Adhesive Cat. NA-1504
$14.95
• 400g • Great for laying speaker carpet in/on
speaker cabinets
Grille Cloth 1.5 x 1m
Cat. CF-2752
$17.50
• Protects expensive drivers
• Allows all sound to get through
Speaker Sealant 2m
Cat. CF-2762
$5.45
• Gets airtight seals between drivers and cabinets
FOR INFORMATION AND ORDERING
TELEPHONE> 1800 022 888
INTERNET> www.jaycar.com.au
Security Accessories to Enhance
your Alarm System
8-Zone 2-Partition Alarm Panel
8 protection zones and 2 zones for panic and duress alarms. Designed for
home and office protection, the system gives local alarm warnings. Supplied
with one alarm control panel and one master control keypad. Programmable
user codes, delays and alarm duration.
Specifications:
Cat. LA-5361
• Operating voltage: 16.5VDC
• Entry delay: 15 - 90 seconds
$199
• Exit delay: 60 seconds
• Alarm duration: 3 - 5 minutes or unlimited
• Alarm outputs: 12VDC, 2.5A
• Dimensions: Control panel - 168(W) x 168(H) x
78(D)mm
• Keypad - 117(W) x 117(H) x 27(D) mm
• Suitable backup battery: 12V, 7.2Ah
available separately - SB-2486
• Suitable 17VAC plugpack: MP-3022
NEW
Due Mid March
AV-Gad Brako Glass Breakage Sensor
Cat. LA-5550
$59.00
Detects shock signal and glass breaking for a false
alarm-free glass break detector
Eyespy 11 PIR with Auto Temp Compensation
Cat. LA-5532
$49.95
Increased performance in warm temperatures and
reduced false alarms in cold temperatures
Plastic Siren Cover
Cat. LA-5112
$19.95
Rust proof and protects an external siren speaker from tampering.
Has pre-drilled holes for strobe mounting and an internal speaker bracket.
12 Volt Photoelectric Smoke Detector
Cat. LA-5045
$19.95
This unit is ideal for permanent wiring in boats, caravans or motorhomes etc.
Fitted with N.O & N.C. contacts to trigger an external alarm.
Dual Infra-Red & Microwave Motion Detector
Cat. LA-5039
$79.95
This dual technology sensor provides the highest detection reliability by combining
both IR and microwave motion detectors in one compact and attractive unit.
NO & NC Reed Switch and Magnet
Cat. LA-5070
$6.25
You have both types of contacts on the one unit. Normally
open (NO) and normally closed (NC) per pair.
Flush Mount Piezo Siren
Cat. LA-5257
$12.95
Modern day replacement for the traditional top hat screamer. Mounts flush in the ceiling
making it less noticeable. Output: 108dB <at> 1m 47mmdia.
Professional Surveillance Cameras - CCD Only
• For reliable, quality installations • Fit either C or CS mount lens
• Feature Auto-Iris output for an Auto-Iris lens, which adjusts to widely changing lighting conditions
• Top and bottom mounting threads for fitting on a standard mounting bracket or indoor/outdoor enclosure
• Use specified regulated 12VDC plugpacks: MP-3011 - $17.95 or MP-3032 - $24.95
• Connections: 2.1mmID/5.5mmOD DC power socket, RCA audio socket and BNC video socket
High Resolution
Colour with Auto-Iris
B&W CCD Camera
- Pro Style
Full range of professional
surveillance DVRs 4, 8 & 16 channel
with 250GB HDD From $499
Day/Night Camera with Sony Super
HAD CCD Sensor
Pro Style - Hi-Res ExView HAD
Colour CCD Camera
Cat. QC-3310
$69
Type
QC-3310
QC-3309
QC-3307
QC-3810
QC-3300
QC-3301
QC-3298
QC-3299
B&W
Colour
Colour
Colour
Colour
Colour
Colour
Colour
Sensor
Brand
Samsung
Sony HAD
Sony HR SuperHAD
Panasonic HR
Sony SuperHAD
Sony HR SuperHAD
Sony ExView HAD
Sony ExView HAD HR
Resolution
Pixels (H x V)
500 x 582
500 x 582
752 x 582
753 x 582
500 x 582
752 x 582
500 x 582
752 x 582
Security
Installing Home Security
Systems Book
Installing home security can
be a daunting task but this
guide will almost certainly
save you time and
frustration. It clearly explains
how to plan positioning of
motion detectors for
maximum efficiency, how to identify
potential entry points for thieves, using
sensors and switches plus basic cabling and
installation. If you're looking to purchase and
install an alarm for the first
Cat. BI-8205
time, this guide is
$2.00
essential reading. A4 8 pages.
Large Alarm Sticker
Cat. LA-5102
$2.25
Oval Alarm Window Sticker
Cat. LA-5104
$2.95
Horizontal
TV Lines
380
350
520
480
380
470
380
470
Min
Lux
0.05
0.3
0.25
1
0.1
0.2
0.05
0.07
Shutter
Speed (sec)
1/100,000
1/100,000
1/100,000
1/100,000
1/110,000
1/110,000
1/110,000
1/110,000
S/N
Ratio
>48dB
>48dB
>48dB
>48dB
>48dB
>48dB
>48dB
>48dB
Current
Draw
120mA
180mA
160mA
100mA
250mA / 3W
290mA / 3.5W
295mA / 5W
295mA / 5W
$290
Weight
630g
630g
290g
250g
610g
610g
610g
610g
Dimensions
(mm)
118 x 62 x 50
118 x 62 x 50
118 x 62 x 50
117 x 60 x 50
130 x 60 x 51
130 x 60 x 51
130 x 60 x 51
130 x 60 x 51
Recommended
Retail Price
$69.00
$149.00
$249.00
$199.00
$199.00
$249.00
$249.00
$299.00
Recommended
Power Supply
Cat. MP-3011
Cat. MP-3011
Cat. MP-3011
Cat. MP-3011
Cat. MP-3032
Cat. MP-3032
Cat. MP-3032
Cat. MP-3032
2.4GHz Transmitter
for Video Cameras
Active Matrix TFT
Security Monitors
This compact transmitter simply plugs
in-line with an ordinary security
camera and turns it into a wireless
unit which can broadcast on one of
four standard channels. The transmitter
operates with all cameras that have a BNC
signal socket and uses the camera's existing power
supply, eliminating additional wiring.
Cat. QC-3594
• Power jumper lead and fixed
$69.95
antenna included
• Measures 35(W) x 40(H) x 60(D)mm
These rugged
high
performance
TFT monitors
are purposebuilt for
demanding
security
applications
and feature a
toughened
screen to
Toughe
prevent
n
damage. The
Glass ed
monitors will
Screen
accept VGA, S-Video, or
composite video input
and have Interlaced to
Cat. QM-3419
Progressive scan.
• Up to 1280 line resolution
$549
• Accepts VESA 100 mounting
• Don't confuse with cheaper non-protected LCD
screens!!
Cat. QM-3420
19" model also available
QM-3420
$649
Commercial Grade Door
Entry Beam
Ideal for use in retail and
commercial
environments. It has
an effective range of
2 - 8 metres, so it is
suitable for most entry
points. Includes mains
Cat. LA-5193
plugpack.
• Optional counter also available
$89.95
Drill not included
FOR INFORMATION AND ORDERING
TELEPHONE> 1800 022 888
Cat. QC-3299
$249
$249
Quick Reference
Cat.
Cat. QC-3301
Cat. QC-3307
INTERNET> www.jaycar.com.au
Better. More Technical
5
VoIP
VoIP or Voice over Internet Protocol is a method for taking analogue signals and turning them into digital data that can be transmitted over the Internet. Perhaps the
biggest incentives of VoIP for the home users are price and flexibility. With VoIP, you can make a call from anywhere you have broadband connectivity and by using
some of the free VoIP software available you can bypass the phone company all together. Both phones compatible with Skype, MSN, Yahoo Messenger,
Xten, Dialpad, MediaRing, and Net2Phone.
USING A VOIP HANDSET
USB Wireless Phone
Broadband Internet
Connection
• Also use as handset for MSN and
Yahoo Messenger's voice service
• Plugs into computer USB port
• Echo eliminating technology
• 30m range
USB VoIP Phone with LCD &
Hands Free
VoIP
Handset
• Plugs straight to a spare USB port on
your computer
• Mobile phone design and crystal clear
sound quality
• Hands Free Function
PC/Laptop
Cat. XC-4968
Cat. XC-4966
$129.95
$49.95
Broadband Router
Memories on Show - 12"
Electronic Photo Frame
Display your digital photos or videos with an MP3
file for background music if you like. The files can
be loaded via a compatible memory card or via a
USB cable (available separately) .You can control
the display for individual images, a slide show or
thumbnails with the remote or with the built-in
keys. A huge 12.1" screen size for maximum
impact.
• Supports SM, SD, XD, MS & MMC Cards
• PSU supplied
Cat. QM-3774
VGA to VIDEO Converter
Use your TV as a
computer monitor.
Great for watching
DVD movies, PC
gaming, presentations,
educational applications or
Internet viewing on TV.
SAVE
• No software required
$10
Was $99.95
$349.95
Cat. XC-4870
$89.95
3.5" HDD Enclosure with PC
Button Back-Up
This tough aluminium enclosure
provides 480Mbps USB2.0
high speed data transfer
with hot swappable,
plug and play.
• Suits most 3.5"
IDE hard
drives.
• One button backup
software for PCs included.
• Hard drive not included
Was $59.95
SAVE
$20
Cat. XC-4660
$39.95
Wireless Networking
6
$50
Cat. YN-8067
$39.95
SAVE
$10
PCMCIA Wireless Network Adaptor
Was $49.95
Cat. YN-8068
$39.95
SAVE
$10
PCI Wireless Network Adaptor
Was $49.95
Cat. YN-8066
$34.95
SAVE
$15
Better. More Technical
Everything you would expect from a modern
network attached storage device and more!
Includes a built-in BitTorrent client that can be
used to download and share files over the
BitTorrent network without the need to have
your computer turned on.
Cat. XC-4677
• Hard drive not included
$149
More homes and offices are being networked without wires.
Here’s the affordable way to be part of the trend.
A range of wireless networking cards to suit all
Book
computers and provisions.
This book covers both the MAC and PC
Common specifications:
environments and will help you set up your
• IEEE 802.11g wireless network compatible.
wireless network like the
Interoperation with IEEE 802.11b 11Mbps networks
Pros. It includes hints on
• 64 / 128 Bit WEP encryption
network security and how to
• 54Mbps high speed transfer rate
prevent outside attack.
• 40 - 100m indoor range
• Soft cover
• 100 - 300m outdoor range
• 560 pages Cat. BP-7100
• Low power consumption
$49.95
• Plug and Play compatible
• Compatible with Win98SE/2000/ME/XP
USB 2.0 Wireless Network Adaptor
Router
SAVE
Was $49.95
This router allows communication
with up to four wireless and
networked computers. It
includes support for
WAN, web based and
remote management,
auto detection and
configuration of ISP, built
in firewall, and more!
• Static and dynamic
routing
Cat. YN-8086
• VPN pass through
$79.95
Was $129.95
NAS Device with Built-in
BitTorrent Client
Multi-Network Cable Tester
with Pin out Indicator
This multi-network cable tester is designed to
quickly test UTP/STP/Coaxial/Modular network
cables by manually or automatically scanning the
wires for continuity, incorrect wiring and
polarisation. It will sequence each connection and
indicate the connections via two 9-way LED bar
graphs. Cables can be checked before or after
installation by using the Remote Terminator
(included). This ingenious cable tester also allows
ground- testing of shielded twisted/pair cables.
• Main Unit: 104 x 62 x 26mm
(LxWxD)
• Active Terminator: 100 x
SAVE
30 x 25mm (LxWxD)
$10
• Requires 1 x 9V battery
• Note: Not suitable for Live
circuits
Cat. XC-5076
Was $39.95
$29.95
Pro Computer Tool Kit
The ideal kit for the computer service professional.
Includes
• 3 solder aid tools
SAVE
• Chrome vanadium
$20
screwdrivers
• Crimping tool
• Shifting spanner Cat. TD-2041
and much more!
$58.95
See our website
or catalogue for full listing
Was $78.95
FOR INFORMATION AND ORDERING
TELEPHONE> 1800 022 888
INTERNET> www.jaycar.com.au
200 Watt Wind Turbine
Generators
These units are quite massive and ruggedly built.
They will generate 200 watts at wind speeds as low
as 8 metres per second. They will deliver useful
power at a gentle 3 metre/sec breeze or give up to
300W at higher wind velocities.
There are two units available: one for 12V systems
and another for 24V systems. The 12V unit has a
16V output and the 24V models has a 28V output
which will charge an appropriate battery bank.
Specifications:
• Rated Power: 200 watts
• Max Power:
300 watts
Cat. MG-4510
• Output Voltage: 12V model: 16V
24V model: 28V
$499
• Output Current at Rated Power:
Cat.
MG-4512
12V model: 16.66A
24V model: 8.33A
$499
• Turbine Start Speed: 3m/s
• Max Wind Speed: 40m/s
• Rotor Dia: 2.1 metres
• No of Blades: 3
• Recommended
Minimum Tower Height: 4.5 metres
• Shipping box dimensions:
Box 1: 74 x 44 x 26cm (weight 50kg)
Box 2: 154 x 24 x 13cm (weight 30kg)
• Total shipping weight: 80kg
Dual Stage Lead-Acid Battery Float Chargers
Fully automatic switchmode battery chargers that will efficiently charge high capacity sealed
and unsealed lead acid batteries then properly maintain them. Just connect and forget.
Specifications:
Cat.
MB-3610
MB-3612
MB-3614
• Max. Current:
6A / 3A +/- 5%
12A / 6A +/- 5% 6A / 3A +/- 5%
• Wattage:
85W
160W
160W
• Equaliser Charge:
14.4V +/- 0.1V
14.4V +/- 0.1V
28.8V +/-0.2V
• Floating Charge
13.8V +/- 0.1V
13.8V +/- 0.1V
27.6V +/-0.2V
• Dimensions WxHxD: 168 x 72 x 45mm 162 x 96 x 48mm 168 x 96 x 48mm
• Weight:
650g
850g
850g
• AC input:
• Efficiency:
5 Volt 3400mAh Li-ion
Battery Pack
Lithium Iron Batteries
Take this back-up battery pack with you and charge
your digital devices when you are away from
home or office. Suitable for many devices
including iPod®, PSP® and mobile phones. The pack
is charged via USB and includes 7 output adaptor
plugs to suit the most popular digital devices.
Lithium Iron (Li Fe) batteries pack 5 - 6 six times
the capacity of ordinary alkaline cells and give a
40-60% cost saving when comparing energy
delivered to price paid.
• SB-2364 1500mAh AAA twin pack
• SB-2366 1200mAh AA twin pack
• Ten year storage life
• 4 x battery pack also available
Note: These are not rechargeable
Cat. SB-2366
$7.95
$69.95
NOTE: iPod® and phone not included
Solar Power System with Lights
10%
OFF EACH
$7.95
Eclipse Lithium 9V
1200mAh Batteries
Cat. MB-3300
Great value! Wide variety of sizes!
On electrical specifications alone, these quality
polycrystalline panels not only stand up to the
name brand solar panels but also feature good
efficiency and panel size to power rating ratios.
They also feature tempered glass protection for
harsh environments, and integrated waterproof
junction boxes with cable glands that are
amongst the best we've ever seen.
$99.95
$99.95
$79.95
Cat. SB-2364
Powertech Polycrystalline Solar Panels
Cat. MB-3614
Cat. MB-3612
Cat. MB-3610
110/220VAC switchable 47 63Hz
>85%
Everything you need to get a basic solar setup off
the ground. All the components needed are
included in the kit: 5 watt solar panel encapsulated
in tempered glass, 7Ah SLA battery and 2 x 12V
5W energy saving fluorescent lights. The battery is
housed in a sturdy metal
enclosure with
DC sockets for all
the connections,
so it's
straightforward to
set up and use.
Cat. MP-4551
$179
Essential for smoke detectors,
wireless alarms, garage
remotes etc. Very dependable.
For the sake of your family fit
your smoke detector with
Lithium batteries.
Note: These are not
rechargeable
2 Pack SB-2396
$22.95
Wind Powered Generator
Experimenters Kit
Learn all about this green
energy source, and the
mechanics of wind
generators. It is supplied in
kit form, so you get to
assemble the whole thing
before you start learning
about how it works. Cat. KJ-6696
$49.95
12 Volt Battery Charging Regulators for Solar Panels
Maintain your battery system in peak condition with one of our solar charge controllers. They are available
with a range of features to suit various installations.
Voltage
12V
12V
12V
12V
12V
12V
Power
5W
10W
20W
65W
80W
120W
Cat
ZM-9071
ZM-9073
ZM-9074
ZM-9076
ZM-9078
ZM-9079
Was
$99.95
$149
$239
$549
$699
$1050
Now
$89.95
$134.10
$215.10
$494.10
$629.10
$945
12V 5A
Cat. AA-0348
$29.95
FOR INFORMATION AND ORDERING
TELEPHONE> 1800 022 888
INTERNET> www.jaycar.com.au
12V 1.5A
Cat. AA-0258
$22.95
12V 6A
Cat. MP-3128
$39.95
12V 20A
Cat. MP-3126
$74.95
Better. More Technical
20A 12V with LCD
Cat. MP-3129
$139.95
7
Kits
UHF Remote Controlled Mains Switch
PIC Based Water Tank
Level Meter Kit
Ref Silicon Chip November 2007
This PIC-based unit uses a pressure sensor to
monitor water level and will display tank level via an
RGB LED at the press of a button. The kit can be
expanded to include and optional wireless remote
display panel that can monitor up to ten separate
tanks (KC-5461) or you can
add a wireless remote
controlled mains power
switch (KC-5462) to control
remote water pumps. Kit
includes electronic
components, case, screen
printed PCB and Cat. KC-5460
pressure sensor.
$99.95
Telemetry Base Station
for Water Tank Level Meter
Ref Silicon Chip February 2008
Commercial remote control mains switches are
available but these are generally limited to a range
of less than 20m. This UHF system will operate
up to 200m and is perfect for remote power
control systems etc. The switch can be activated
using the included hand held controller or our
KC-5461 water tank level sensor base station. Kit
supplied with case, screen
printed PCB, RF modules
and all
electronic
components.
Ref Silicon Chip January 2008
This Base Station is intended for use with the
telemetry version of the KC-5460 water tank level
meter. It has an inbuilt 433MHz wireless receiver
and can handle data transmissions from up to 10
level meters and display the results on a
2-line 32-character LCD module.
Kit includes electronic
components, case,
screen printed
PCB and RF
module.
Cat. KC-5462
Cat. KC-5461
$99.95
$79.95
Save on Digital Multimeters
Computer Connect Auto Range DMM
Sensational Value DMM
With the ability to analyse and store information on
your home or notebook computer, this meter
is ideally suited to laboratory or fieldwork.
The software features data logging, with
information displayed on a graph or simple
list. When recording, you have the option of
recording continuously or in preset time
gaps. Min/max/avg information can also be
displayed. The information can be exported
to spreadsheet programs such as
Excel for further analysis.
• 3.7 Digit
• Diode Test
• 10 Amp AC & DC current
• Data Hold
Cat. QM-1538
• Software included
$29.95
Was $39.95
SAVE
$10
SAVE
$40
$7.95
QM-1564 Mini AC/DC Current Clamp Meter with
Non-contact Voltage Sensor available separately
Was $99.95 Now $79.95 Save $20.00
SAVE
$40
QM-1290
SAVE
$15
QM-1462
Cat.
QM-1290
QM-1462
QM-1541
QM-1539
Ideal for car stereo installations and
electrical trades people.
• 200A AC/DC
• Frequency
• Capacitance
• Autoranging
• Auto power off
• Data hold
• Zero function
• Duty Cycle
• Continuity Buzzer
Cat. QM-1562
• Carry case included
$99.95
• 4000 count
Was $139.95
Cat. QM-1500
SAVE
$50
Description
Protek 506
USB Computer Connect
IP67 Harsh Environment
Cat III DMM
AC/DC Current Clamp Meter
Excellent budget digital multimeter
packed with features.
• 3.5 Digit
• 12.5mm high LCD
• Transistor test
• Diode test
• 10 Amp current
• Plug-in leads
Safety Category
Cat III 600V
Cat IV 600V
Cat IV 600V
Cat III 600V
SAVE
$20
QM-1539
Display
4000 Count
4000 Count
4000 Count
4000 Count
QM-1541
Features
20A Current, TrueRMS, RS232
20A Current, USB Interface
Large Display, IP67
Large Display
Was
$198.00
$139.95
$99.95
$59.95
Now
$148.00
$99.95
$79.95
$44.95
See our website or ask in-store for full specifications
YOUR LOCAL JAYCAR STORE
Australia Freecall Orders: Ph 1800 022 888
NEW SOUTH WALES
Albury
Ph (02)
Alexandria
Ph (02)
Bankstown
Ph (02)
Blacktown
Ph (02)
Bondi Junction Ph (02)
Brookvale
Ph (02)
Campbelltown Ph (02)
Erina
Ph (02)
Gore Hill
Ph (02)
Hornsby
Ph (02)
Newcastle
Ph (02)
Parramatta
Ph (02)
Penrith
Ph (02)
Rydalmere
Ph (02)
8
6021
9699
9709
9678
9369
9905
4620
4365
9439
9476
4965
9683
4721
8831
6788
4699
2822
9669
3899
4130
7155
3433
4799
6221
3799
3377
8337
3151
Silverwater
Sydney City
Taren Point
Tweed Heads
Wollongong
VICTORIA
Coburg
Frankston
Geelong
Melbourne
Ringwood
Springvale
Sunshine
Thomastown
QUEENSLAND
Aspley
Cairns
Better. More Technical
Prices valid until March 31st 2008
Ph
Ph
Ph
Ph
Ph
(02)
(02)
(02)
(07)
(02)
9741
9267
9531
5524
4226
8557
1614
7033
6566
7089
Ph
Ph
Ph
Ph
Ph
Ph
Ph
Ph
(03)
(03)
(03)
(03)
(03)
(03)
(03)
(03)
9384
9781
5221
9663
9870
9547
9310
9465
1811
4100
5800
2030
9053
1022
8066
3333
Ph (07) 3863 0099
Ph (07) 4041 6747
ORDER FREE CALL>
Ipswich
Ph (07) 3282 5800
Maroochydore Ph (07) 5479 3511
Mermaid Beach Ph (07) 5526 6722
Townsville
Ph (07) 4772 5022
Underwood
Ph (07) 3841 4888
Woolloongabba Ph (07) 3393 0777
AUSTRALIAN CAPITAL TERRITORY
Belconnen
Ph (02) 6253 5700
Fyshwick
Ph (02) 6239 1801
TASMANIA
Hobart
Ph (03) 6272 9955
SOUTH AUSTRALIA
Adelaide
Ph (08) 8231 7355
Clovelly Park Ph (08) 8276 6901
Gepps Cross
Ph (08) 8262 3200
WESTERN AUSTRALIA
Maddington
Ph (08) 9493 4300
1800 022 888
INTERNET>
Northbridge
Ph (08) 9328 8252
NORTHERN TERRITORY
Darwin
Ph (08) 8948 4043
NEW ZEALAND
Christchurch Ph (03) 379 1662
Dunedin
Ph (03) 471 7934
Glenfield
Ph (09) 444 4628
Hamilton
Ph (07) 846 0177
Manukau
Ph (09) 263 6241
Newmarket
Ph (09) 377 6421
Palmerston Nth Ph (06) 353 8246
Wellington
Ph (04) 801 9005
Freecall Orders Ph 0800 452 9227
www.jaycar.com.au
SILICON
CHIP
Order
Form/Tax Invoice
Silicon Chip Publications Pty Ltd
ABN 49 003 205 490
www.siliconchip.com.au
PRICE GUIDE: SUBSCRIPTIONS
YOUR DETAILS
(Note: all subscription prices include P&P).
(Aust. prices include GST)
Your Name________________________________________________________
(PLEASE PRINT)
Organisation (if applicable)___________________________________________
Please state month to start.
Australia: 1 yr ...................... $A89.50
1 yr + binder ....................... $A105
NZ (air): 1 yr ....................... $A96
Overseas (air): 1 yr ............. $A135
2 yrs ...................... $A172
2 yrs + 2 binders .... $A203
2 yrs ...................... $A190
2 yrs ...................... $A260
Address__________________________________________________________
PRICE GUIDE: OTHER PRODUCTS
_________________________________________________________________
Postcode_____________ Daytime Phone No. (
)_____________________
Email address (if applicable) ___________________________________________
(all prices include GST on Aust. orders)
*SILICON CHIP BACK ISSUES in stock: 10% discount for
10 or more issues or photocopies. Australia: $A9.50 ea
(including p&p). Overseas: $A13 each (including p&p by air).
Method of Payment:
*ELECTRONICS AUSTRALIA: project photocopies. Australia:
$A9.50 each (including p&p). Overseas: $A13 each (including
p&p by air).
o Cheque/Money Order o Visa Card o Master Card
*BINDERS: BUY 5 or more and get them postage free.
(Available in Aust. only): $A13.95 each plus $7 p&p per order.
*ELECTRONICS PROJECTS FOR CARS, VOL.2: Aust.
$A14.95; Overseas $A18.00. (Prices include p&p & GST
where applicable).
Card No.
*PERFORMANCE ELECTRONICS FOR CARS: Aust.
$A22.50; Overseas $A26.00. (Prices include p&p & GST
where applicable).
Card expiry date:
Signature_____________________________
SUBSCRIBERS QUALIFY FOR 10% DISCOUNT ON ALL SILICON CHIP PRODUCTS*
* except subscriptions/renewals
Qty
Item
Price
Item Description
Subscribe to SILICON CHIP on-line at: www.siliconchip.com.au
Both printed and on-line versions available
Total
TO PLACE
YOUR
ORDER
siliconchip.com.au
P&P if
extra
Total
Price
BUY
MOR 10 OR
ISSU E BACK
ES
A 1 0 & G ET
DISC %
OUN
T
$A
Phone (02) 9939 3295
9am-5pm Mon-Fri
Please have your credit
card details ready
OR
Fax this form to
(02) 9939 2648
with your credit card details
24 hours 7 days a week
OR
Mail this form, with your
cheque/money order, to:
Silicon Chip Publications Pty Ltd,
PO Box 139, Collaroy, NSW,
March
Australia
20972008 57
03/08
A Digital VFO with
Graphics Display
This DDS VFO uses a widely available recycled Nokia
cellular phone LCD to display analog and digital frequency
readouts, text, and VFO status messages
F
or several years, I’ve wanted
to build my own DDS (Direct
Digital Synthesis) VFO (Variable
Frequency Oscillator).
Analog Devices makes one of the
most popular ranges of DDS chips
which digitally generate precise sine
waves covering frequencies from
practically “DC to daylight”; well, up
to many hundreds of MHz.
Some time ago I managed to obtain
several samples but, for some time
afterwards, that was as far as things
went. I was just too busy with work
and family to devote any time to the
project.
In addition, I couldn’t locate a suitable design to build. Practically all
existing designs use one of the PIC
microprocessor family. Others use
several PIC microprocessors; yet others use a further large bunch of ICs to
interface displays and keypad functions. With my microprocessor development tools all focused on the 8051
family – and being fundamentally of
a contrary nature – I was determined
to use an 8051 chip in my DDS VFO
rather than mess about gearing up for
another microprocessor, and keep the
chip count minimal.
Underlying this was a feeling that
if I wrote my own software, I could
customise it to suit my precise requirements and be better placed to develop
one or two other DDS-based projects I
have in mind. Of course, that naively
assumes I’ll find the time to complete
those new designs.
Fig.1: the promise of things to come? The DDS VFO with its cellular phone “readout” mounted inside an HF transceiver
the author is currently working on . . .
58 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
h LCD
CLOCK
fc
by Andrew Woodfield
ZL2PD
ADDRESS
COUNTER
n bits
SINEWAVE
LOOKUP
REGISTER
DIGITAL TO
ANALOG
CONVERTER
fOUT
DIGITAL TO
ANALOG
CONVERTER
fOUT
Fig.3: basic Direct Digital Synthesis system.
FIG 3: BASIC DIRECT DIGITAL SYNTHESIS SYSTEM
PHASE ACCUMULATOR
TUNING
WORD
M
24–48
bits
n bit carry
n bits
PHASE
REGISTER
14–16
bits
PHASE TO
AMPLITUDE
CONVERTER
SYSTEM
CLOCK
fc
Operator interface
Let’s not forget the operator interface.
Practically all existing designs use a
standard 2 line x 20 character alphanumeric display. An earlier popular design used high current seven segment
LED displays. The size of both of these
displays and the limited information
presented to the operator didn’t seem
ideal to me.
They certainly weren’t well suited
for the small HF transceiver I’ve also
been building.
This led to another delay while I
looked for alternative displays and a
series of experiments with some small
cheap, graphical LCD modules.
These monochrome LCDs were
used in many older cellular phones,
as well as in some current low cost
entry-level models.
I built several small projects using one of the most commonly used
Fig.2: the readout, from a Nokia
cellular phone, is capable of
displaying simple graphics . . .
siliconchip.com.au
Fig.4: a typical Direct Digital Synthesis system.
FIG 4: TYPICAL DIRECT DIGITAL SYNTHESIS SYSTEM
graphical LCDs, the Nokia 3310 LCD
module. This LCD turned out to be
very useful – It offers a 84 x 48 pixel
display with a visible area of about
35mm x 25 mm.
DDS Oscillators
Direct digital synthesis (DDS) is a
digital method to generate waveforms,
usually sine waves.
In contrast to the more common
phase locked loop (PLL) approach
which uses a voltage controlled oscillator, digital dividers and a phase
detector to generate frequencies in
defined steps, data stored in an internal DDS chip table is passed to a
digital to analog (D/A) converter at a
specific clock rate. If the table contains
values equivalent to the amplitude
of a sine wave, then a sinewave at a
frequency related to the clock rate will
be produced.
One such basic DDS is illustrated
in Fig.3.
By changing the clock speed, a wide
range of sinewave frequencies can be
generated. If the clock is fast enough,
frequencies can readily be generated
across wide ranges, and at sub-Hz
increments.
The completely digital nature of the
DDS oscillator and its ability to generate very fine frequency increments are
the main advantages over PLLs.
In practice, a DDS device uses the
arrangement shown in Fig.4. The tuning word, which is usually 32 or 48
bits wide, is used to modify a phase
accumulator. This outputs a 14-16 bit
word for onward signal generation.
With this approach and with a
32-bit tuning word, it is possible to
generate more than 4 billion specific
frequencies.
For more information on DDS chips,
the introductory documents on the
Fig.5: and here it’s shown mounted on the back of the PC board, along with the six
control switches. There are minor differences to the correct layout shown in Fig.8.
March 2008 59
bands. The LCD modules the current
operating frequency and mode of the
VFO. A key feature of this design is
an analog-style graphics-driven dial
displayed on the LCD which sweeps
up and down just like a conventional
mechanical dial while tuning the
VFO.
The VFO also features two independent VFOs, a programmable
receiver IF offset capability, full RIT,
and VFO locking.
All of this software is handled
within a single 20-pin low cost Atmel
89C4051 microprocessor.
The DDS drivers within the microprocessor are quite compact, but
much of the space within the 4K bytes
of flash program memory is actually
required for lookup tables to handle
the Nokia 3310 LCD.
Unlike standard 2 line x 20 character
alphanumeric displays, all of the information displayed has to be generated,
dot by dot, by the 89C4051 microprocessor. Each and every character, every
graphical feature, all resides within the
4K of program memory.
The VFO code itself amounts to less
than 1.5Kbytes, the balance taken up
by the graphics tables. There is also
some room in the program memory to permit other builders
to add features to
suit individual
Fig.6: there are two ways to construct
the DDS VFO – cut the board and “sandwich” the
two sections as shown here, or leave the board intact
(the tracks for the two sections are provided). As you can
see from this photo, the component side of the PC board(s)
is a groundplane, formed by using double-sided PC board blank.
Analog Devices website at www.analog.
com are highly recommended.
The most significant problems with
DDS oscillators are noise and spurious
emissions. These can be minimised by
using D/A converters with relatively
long digital words. Many DDS devices
are limited to 10-bit words but newer
devices more often use 12-bit or 14bit words.
This DDS VFO uses an Analog Devices AD9850 chip which uses a 10-bit
D/A. This delivers a spurious emission
level of -50dB.
Frequencies are selected using 32
bits of a 40 bit tuning word, allowing
better than 0.03Hz frequency steps
60 Silicon Chip
At right is the
optical encoder,
made from a surplus
mechanical mouse
with the 80MHz DDS clock used in
this design. The balance of the 40 bit
word is used for phase and control
functions.
Since this level of resolution exceeds most requirements, many DDS
VFO designs use a larger step size. In
this VFO design, the user can select
10Hz, 100Hz or 1kHz steps to give
three tuning rates – slow, medium
and fast.
Functionality
The DDS VFO covers all amateur
radio bands between 160m and 10m
in 10Hz, 100Hz or 1kHz increments,
and will happily tune outside of these
requirements.
The code uses no special features of
the AT89C4051 and so it may be used
with almost any 8051-type processor
possessing adequate memory.
One option might be the addition
of country-specific frequencies, for
example, not currently supported by
the present VFO software. To that end,
the fully commented source code is
available from my website, as well as
the Intel hex file for direct programming of blank microprocessors.
The Design
In contrast to other designs, this
DDS VFO design is almost minimalsiliconchip.com.au
siliconchip.com.au
March 2008 61
LOCK
VFO A/B
PTT
RIT
4
IC1b
22pF
22pF
10k
+5V
7
IC1: LM393
1
X1 8.866MHz
22k
5
6
8
IC1a
10k
RST
5
4
12
16
15
14
13
X2
X1
P1.0
P1.4
P1.3
P1.2
P1.1
7 P3.3
INT1
6 P3.2
INT0
1
GND
10
IC2
AT89C4051
Vdd
20
P3.0
P3.1
P3.4
P1.5
P1.6
P1.7
P3.7
A
A
A
Vo
CS
5
8
7
9
7
2
IC3
80MHz
OSC
8
3
14
100nF
7
+5V
8
Rset
D2
Vddd
2
5,24
Dgnd
CLKin
22
10,19
Agnd
RST
IoutB
20
12
3,4,
6,23
100nF
56
100
10 F
IN
150pF
33pF
L2 330nH*
IN
100pF
100nF
1
2,4
3
A
A
K
OUT
100nF
RFC3
100 H
120
K
12V
DC
RF
OUT
2
3
ERA-4
LEDS
ADJ
BEVELLED 4
END
1
IN
–
+
LM317LZ
RFC4 100 H
1N4148
47 F
IC5
ERA-4
LCD MODULE
PINOUTS
(REAR VIEW)
1
8
OUT
GND
IN
7805
GND
OUT
REG1 7805
* L1: 13 turns on T25-10
L2: 12 turns on T25-10
100pF
10pF
L1 390nH*
100nF
ADJ
OUT
REG2 LM317LZ
RFC2 100 H
470
10 F
330
LED1
330
3.9k
4.7 F
10k
+3.3V
K
A
IC4 Iout 21
AD9850
DDS+DAC
Wclk
Fu/d
SDin
11,18
Vdda
RFC1 100 H
GND
6
RST
NOKIA
3310
LCD
MODULE
V+
1
25
100nF
3x
10k
NOT
USED
1 F
SDA
SCL
4 D/C
3
2
LED2
1k
8
9
K
A
3x
10k
D1– D3
1N4148
17 K
18 K
19 K
11
100nF
DDS DRIVEN VARIABLE FREQUENCY OSCILLATOR
BAND
2x
10k
STEP
2
3
10k
10 F
Fig.7: the complete DDO VFO circuit diagram. Using the cellphone display
certainly simplifies things!
2008
SC
TUNING
OPTICAL
ENCODER
560
100nF
+5V
12V DC IN
14
IN TO
IC1 PIN 3
2x 22pF
NOT
USED
10k
100nF
IC1
LM393
10k
560
IC3
80MHz OSC
18030340
OFV SDD
A
K
ENCODER
LED
5V
22k
10k
4148 D1
4148 D2
4148 D3
+
100nF
REG1
100nF
REG2
10 F
10k
10k
10k
S3
S2
S4
S5
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
330
470
+
1 F
+
10 F
+
4.7 F
S1
NOKIA 3310
LCD MODULE
S6
1k
28030340
LED1
OFV SDD
LED2
= BOTTOM LAYER
COPPER
(TRACKS)
= TOP LAYER
COPPER
(GROUNDPLANE)
Fig.8: component overlay for the top (ground plane) side. Here the two parts of the
PC board are shown still connected; the links (shown in green) are only required if
you split the board and “sandwich” it.
ist, using just four chips (excluding
the regulators): the microprocessor,
the optical encoder interface chip, the
DDS, and the RF amplifier chip.
This avoids the approach used in
a number of other designs which requires a microprocessor dedicated to
the encoder and display and a second
processor dedicated to the DDS.
The microprocessor is also operated
at a very leisurely 8MHz. I actually
used a PAL TV colour-burst crystal
of 8.866MHz but any crystal from 8
to 12MHz will likely work fine. The
top speed for this micro is 24MHz, so
clearly nothing much is being pushed
hard in this design.
This might suggest that the 8051 is
significantly more efficient than other
8-bit microprocessors used in similar
designs.
My software is all written in handcoded assembler, often far more effi-
A NOTE TO
SILICON
CHIP
SUBSCRIBERS
Your magazine address sheet shows when
your current subscription expires.
Check it out to see how many you still have.
If your magazine has not turned up by the
first week of the month, contact us at
silchip<at>siliconchip.com.au
62 Silicon Chip
+
47 F
330
IN TO
IC1 PIN 5
TO/FROM OPTICAL ENCODER
–
RFC4
10k
8
100nF
+
10k
1
+
RFC1
RFC2
100nF
100pF
56
100
100pF
7
10 F
10k
10k
X1
8.866MHz
33pF
10k
10k
3.9k
150pF
IC2 AT89C4051
120
L1
L2
100nF
100nF
RFC3
10pF
RF OUT
cient than higher level languages and
the code possibly also makes a little
better use of interrupts.
This approach allows the optical
encoder (the main tuning control) to
be very rapidly read without causing
any measurable delays in the main
DDS and display routines despite the
fairly intensive data transfers required
by the Nokia 3310 LCD whenever it is
being updated.
Interrupt-driven routines tend to
be a little more complex to write but
are necessary here to handle rapid
updating of the digital display and
the analog dial graphics, while also
reading the dial and checking for any
pressed buttons.
These functions can add up to quite
a lot of work for this modest 8051
microprocessor to manage but it is
made possible by minimal mainline
software functions and a relatively
fast background interrupt cycle. This
interrupt cycle is focused on reading
the encoder, the most time-critical
function.
When power is applied to the VFO,
the microprocessor begins by initializing the LCD module. These feature
a brief animated set of graphics which
illustrate some of the flexibility of the
display and makes use of some spare
ROM space. The 89C4051 then initialises the DDS VFO to the bottom of
the 80m band in receive mode, with
an offset assuming an IF of 8.467MHz,
and with RIT (receiver incremental
tuning) turned off.
These parameters are all set by the
software, and are very easy to change
to suit other applications and user
preferences. These settings are all
very clearly highlighted in the source
code.
The DDS requires a 40-bit serial
word transfer from the microprocessor.
As the encoder is rotated, the DDS frequency is updated, the new frequency
displayed and the dial graphics dynamically changed according to the
direction of tuning knob rotation.
The 40-bit word sent to the DDS is
calculated from a series of predetermined lookup values, one for each
digit in the 7-digit frequency of the
VFO, the values depending on the DDS
clock used.
In this case, they assume an 80MHz
clock, the highest frequency crystal
Fig.9: soldering that SMD-mount chip
requires a steady hand and a fine iron
(see the SMD article in this issue!)
siliconchip.com.au
oscillator I could buy locally.
The DDS output is filtered using a
5th order elliptical low pass filter with
a cutoff frequency of about 35MHz. The
output from the filter is then amplified
with a ERA-4 surface mount MMIC.
This gives a output level of about 1V
peak-to-peak or +13dBm into 50W from
the VFO, ideal for diode mixers. Since
the DDS output level follows a sinx/x
envelope, the output reduces to 0.8V
peak-to-peak by 30MHz. This 2dB
rolloff is of little concern in transceiver
applications but should be borne in
mind if this software is used for signal
generator applications.
The 80MHz DDS oscillator is the reference for the VFO’s output frequency.
By contrast, the microprocessor crystal
is a nominal 8MHz crystal and, as
noted earlier, its exact frequency is
not critical. Since output frequency
accuracy and stability depends on the
80MHz DDS oscillator (and few of these
have any external frequency adjustments available), any users requiring
absolute output frequency accuracy can
make the simple frequency alignment
adjustments within the software.
I found my VFO was accurate to a
few hundred Hertz and quite adequate
for my uses.
The Nokia 3310 LCD module requires a 3.3V supply. While some 8051
chips will operate on the same 3V supply, the 80MHz oscillator demands a
5V supply. The decision was therefore
made to run both a 5V (for micro and
oscillator) and a 3.3V rail for the LCD.
It’s a slight additional complexity but
makes the design easier to convert to
other types of 8051 chips should this
prove desirable.
The interface between the AT89C4051
and the display, necessary due to the
different supply rails on these parts,
is handled with three cheap isolating
diodes. If you are able to purchase some
3.3V clock oscillators (a standard part
but one I couldn’t buy locally), you can
easily modify the entire VFO for single
supply rail operation.
The microprocessor interface for
the LCD module uses fewer control
lines than suggested in many references. Most suggest the need for five
lines, including a reset line from the
microprocessor. Careful reading of
the datasheet revealed that the chip
select (CS) line can be permanently
tied to ground at the cost of a little
more current.
The VFO’s MMIC amplifier is fairly
siliconchip.com.au
Figs.10 & 11: here’s the full size artwork for both sides of the PC board with the
top (ground plane) at right. We imagine most constructors will not bother etching
a second layer (if they can!) but will simply remove the top-side copper around
the holes with a small twist drill (eg, 5mm). It’s tedious but easy enough to do
holding the drill in your fingers, putting the tip in the hole and twisting. The
smaller holes in the ground plane are for the components which solder to both
sides of the board – these should not be opened out.
greedy, drawing around 65mA, so the
modest constant 5mA consumed by
the always-on LCD turned out to be of
little concern. The datasheet also suggested the possibility of using a resistorcapacitor reset arrangement (10kW and
4.7mF), and that saved a further I/O
pin. As a result, there is an additional
delay of a hundred milliseconds or so
at power-up, just to be sure the display
has reset but this is of little importance
in overall operation.
The main dial knob uses connects to
an optical encoder. This is interfaced
to the microprocessor with an LM393
comparator to ensure clean rising and
falling quadrature signals. The use of
an optical encoder delivers improved
long term reliability and allows users
to set up the mechanics of the dial knob
to suit individual taste.
Construction
The VFO can be built either as a
single PC board measuring about 150
x 50 x 15mm (wxhxd) or in a sandwiched two-PC board configuration
measuring 100 x 50 x 25mm (wxhxd).
Those wanting a smaller version can
convert the current layout to use SMD
March 2008 63
Parts List – DDS VFO
1 double-sided PC board, 150 x 50mm, coded 06103081 (see text)
1 digital display ex Nokia 3310 cellular phone (see text)
1 surplus mechanical (ball-type) mouse for optical encoder parts (containing 1 LED and 2 phototransistors – see text)
1 8.866MHz crystal (X1)
6 PC mounting SPST pushbutton switches
Semiconductors
1 LM393 (IC1)
1 AT89C4051 microcontroller (IC2)
1 80MHz oscillator (IC3)
1 AD9850 (IC4)
1 ERA4 (IC5)
1 7805 5V positive voltage regulator (REG1)
1 LM317LZ voltage regulator (REG2)
3 1N4148 silicon signal diodes (D1-3)
1 yellow LED
1 green LED
Capacitors
1 10mF 16V PC electrolytic
3 10mF 10V PC electrolytic
1 4.7mF 10V PC electrolytic
1 1mF 10V PC electrolytic
7 100nF polyester
1 150pF polyester
2 100pF polyester or ceramic
1 33pF ceramic
2 22pF ceramic
1 10pF ceramic
Inductors
1 390nH (L1)
1 330nH (L2)
4 100mH (RFC1-4)
(code 0.1, 100n or 104)
(code 150p or 151)
(code 100p or 101)
(code 33p or 33)
(code 22p or 22)
(code 10p or 10)
(13T 33SWG ENCU on T25-10 toroidal former)
(12T 33SWG ENCU on T25-10 toroidal former)
Resistors (all 0.25W, 1%)
1 22kW
12 10kW
1 470W
2 330W
1 3.9kW
1 120W
parts and reduce the dimensions by
about 40%. While the present design
uses a double sided PC board, the
top side of the board is left unetched,
forming a continuous copper ground.
This allows the PC board to be etched
in typical home workshops with ease
as if it was a single sided PC board.
That’s the method I used for the version pictured.
While I’ve used standard components as far as possible, construction
is not for the faint-hearted. The DDS
chip, for example, is a 28 pin SMD
device with very close pin spacing.
The display connections are also challenging. Time and care allows both
to be soldered into place but it does
require a good soldering iron with a
fine tip, steady hands, patience and
good eyesight.
I’d suggest building the keyboard/
64 Silicon Chip
1 1kW
1 100W
1 560W
1 56W
display PC board first. Install the
jumpers first, the resistors, then the
buttons, and finally mount the display.
The Nokia 3310 display is supplied
mounted on a plastic keypad frame
assembly complete with speaker.
Prise out the speaker – it’s just
pressed into a rubber ring – and trim
the surplus plastic away with a sharp
knife, being careful not to disturb the
plastic around the display itself. This
is essential to maintain slight compression on the metallic springs which
press onto the conductive tracks on
the LCD glass.
The display is then wired to the
pads on the PC board. I was tempted
to lay the PC board out to permit the
display to be directly mounted on it
but the current method offers a little
more flexibility. However, it does require some delicate soldering of wire
jumpers between the spring metal
connections on the rear of the display
and the PC board.
I kept everything in place with a
few dabs of hot glue and the display
assembly was mounted a few millimetres off the PC board with three further
strategic dabs of hot glue. This sounds
crude – but it’s unseen and the glue
forms a very rigid arrangement which
can be easily adjusted with a little heat
from a soldering iron.
The display is extremely light, and
the resulting mounting is very robust.
There is also space beneath the LCD
for the addition of backlighting, perhaps using some diffused LEDs, if
desired, although the current PC board
layout does not allow for component
wiring.
By the way, don’t be tempted to remove the white plastic material from
the rear of the LCD. This improves
display contrast and aids backlighting. I
tried some green LEDs for backlighting
and they worked very well, so I may
add these to the final transceiver.
An extra pullup resistor (10kW) can
be seen in Fig.5 mounted next to the
inter-PC board wiring on the top side
of the keyboard/display PC board.
This was caused by a minor change in
pin connections when going from my
Veroboard and wirewrap prototype to
the final PC board version. This resistor
IC1
PIN 1
IC1
PIN 7
ENCODER OUTPUTS WITH POSITIVE (CLOCKWISE) ROTATION
IC1
PIN 1
IC1
PIN 7
ENCODER OUTPUTS WITH NEGATIVE (ANTICLOCKWISE) ROTATION
Fig.12 :
quadrature
outputs from an
optical encoder
are used to tune
the DDS.
siliconchip.com.au
siliconchip.com.au
54
95
28
59
8
44
Notes:
38
40
1. Red lines and dimensions in red text indicate details specific to the DDS VFO. All other dimensions may be varied to suit specific applications.
2. Panel material should be removed from the shaded area.
3. Dotted lines show outlines of LCD display and other panel-mounted components
Fig.13 : same-sized diagram of the front panel of the
transceiver on P58 showing where the VFO mounts.
4. All dimensions are in mm
40
21
54
28
has now been added to the PC board
layout shown in Figure 8 and 9.
Constructing the DDS/microprocessor PC board can start with the installation of the resistors and capacitors.
Then proceed to add the jumpers
and the various through-PC board
connections if your board does not
have plated-through holes. Mount
the microprocessor socket (I strongly
recommend using a “machine screw”
IC socket for non-plated through PC
boards), the LM393, crystal oscillator
and crystal.
The LM393 does not need a socket.
Complete the board by soldering in
the DDS chip and the ERA-4 MMIC.
The optical encoder should be
added next. Although you can use a
commercial model, I made my optical
encoder from parts salvaged from an
old PC mechanical-type mouse. It’s
not a difficult task – there are enough
bits inside an old mouse for two such
encoders.
It is possible to monitor the two
output pins of the LM393 interface to
confirm correct quadrature waveforms
using an oscilloscope (See Fig.12)
while rotating the encoder.
If you test without the microprocessor installed, which is best, you will
need to add temporary pullup resistors on each open-collector comparator output. Any value from 4.7kW to
100kW works fine for testing. Remove
these once encoder testing is complete.
Fig.12 shows the ideal waveforms. Actual outputs have less perfect shapes,
with variable width and timing but
still do the job.
The LCD module and pushbuttons
are mounted on the solder side of the
PC board. This allows the board to be
mounted at the ideal distance from
the front panel for display visibility
and for the buttons to be depressed
through a Lexan or similar flexible
keypad/panel.
Since my workshop facilities
doesn’t run to Lexan production facilities, I made a workable flexible front
panel from transparent plastic stick-on
film from the local stationery shop and
a laser-printed paper panel overlay.
Unfortunately, my panel layout is
too long to be printed here but it can
be downloaded from my website (see
references) or from www.siliconchip.
com.au
The film is layered over the paper
on both sides and provides protection
for the display while allowing the
March 2008 65
buttons to be easily pressed under the
appropriate keypad label.
This panel will obviously wear out
much faster than Lexan but it’s cheap
and easy to make and replace.
There are two indicator LEDs on the
PC board. The green LED shows when
DC is applied to the board and can be
used as a power indicator (Top left hand
corner of the front panel in Fig.10).
The yellow LED was used during the
software development to measure the
time taken by the main software loop.
It still does, changing state each time
through the loop, flickering in varying
degrees of brightness as buttons are
pressed, the VFO is tuned, and the LCD
updated. I located this LED at top dead
centre over the main tuning knob. Yes,
I confess, it’s purely for there for show,
so just omit it if you don’t like it.
The two PC boards are connected
together using a total of 12 short wire
links. There is a further short wire
jumper which is run between the two
boards for the +12V supply. This goes
to the 120W resistor to power the MMIC.
Operation
With an 80MHz DDS clock, the VFO
will operate with minimal spurious
outputs up to about 30MHz. In transmit mode, the DDS VFO outputs the
frequency displayed on the LCD.
In receive mode, the receiver IF
offset is added to the displayed output
frequency until the actual DDS output
frequency exceeds about 30MHz. At
that point, the IF offset is subtracted
from the nominal output frequency to
keep spurious products to an acceptable minimum.
The VFO keys have the following
functions:
LINE
FUNCTION
1
Reserved for a 14 character string of text including the user’s callsign
2
Digital display of VFO frequency
3
Used by the VFO cursor which indicates the step size currently in use
4
Analog dial display
5
RIT frequency (Only shown in RIT mode)
6
Status messages including VFO lock, VFO A/B selection, and Tx mode
Line 1 is the top-most LCD line. Incidentally, lines in the software are actually
numbered from 0 to 5 to match the LCD controller’s addressing scheme.
addresses the display using this linebased mode as shown above.
Also mentioned earlier, the VFO
has three tuning speeds, selected by
the Step key. Some consideration was
given to adding variable rate tuning to
this VFO. This method is used on some
commercial transceivers. As the dial
is rotated more quickly, for example,
the tuning rate will initially directly
match the increased rotation speed.
Then, if the tuning rate is sustained,
the VFO frequency increment will be
automatically increased, resulting in
accelerated tuning, with the frequency
being incremented at a much faster
rate. When the dial is slowed, this is
detected and the tuning rate switches
to a slower rate.
Having used it in one of the commercial transceivers I own, I’ve not found
it particularly pleasant to use. Call me
old-fashioned but I prefer the standard fast/slow tuning speed selection
used in one of my older commercial
transceivers.
I did try a variety of variable rate
methods during the development of
this design but none really proved to
offer any benefits over the scheme finally adopted. So, variable rate tuning
VFO KEY FUNCTIONS:
Step
Selects VFO frequency increment (10Hz, 100Hz or 1kHz steps)
Band
Selects desired band (160m, 80m, 60m, 40m, 30m, 20m, 15m, 12m, 10m)
RIT
Changes dial to RIT control allowing the receiver frequency to be offset
by ±5kHz in 10Hz steps
VFO A/B
Selects one of two independent VFO frequency banks
Lock
Locks the VFO frequency to the currently selected DDS output frequency
Tx
Removes the receiver IF and RIT offsets from the VFO output frequency
As mentioned earlier, the LCD is
addressed as a 6-line display, each 8
pixels high and 84 pixels wide. This is
determined by the LCD controller chip
bonded inside the Nokia 3310 display,
a Philips PCD8544 or equivalent.
The DDS VFO software therefore
66 Silicon Chip
is not a standard feature in this VFO.
Construction Options
The split PC board layouts used in
this design readily permit the use of
other keypads and displays. In such
cases, only the DDS/microprocessor
board need be built. The relevant port
lines are all available on the edge of
this PC board.
With minor changes in software,
those standard two-line x 16 character
alphanumeric LCD modules may be
used, as may many different keypad
arrangements and keypads. In most
such cases, the software will readily
fit in the smaller AT89C2051 (2K flash
ROM) microprocessor which is 100%
pin-compatible with the DDS/microprocessor board layout shown here.
If there is sufficient interest, I will
make schematics, connection details
and software available on my website
for this alternate version.
Future Development
Now that this design is complete, I
want to find some time to build an RF
signal generator using the more powerful AD9854 or AD9912 DDS chips.
These DDS devices have higher quality
quadrature outputs and are ideal for use
with software-based receivers.
Interestingly, a simple signal generator actually requires much less code
than a ham-band transceiver VFO. But
to compensate for this, I’d like to use
one of the more complex full-colour
cellular phone LCD modules.
All I have to do is persuade my wife
to let me borrow her new cellphone for
a few minutes…
SC
References
1. The ZL2PD website can be found at
www.zl2pd.com This contains all of the
source code, assembled hex files, full
size schematics and PCB artwork for free
downloading
2. Analog Devices, ‘A Technical Tutorial on
Digital Signal Synthesis’, 1999 (See www.
analog.com)
3. Two websites offering Nokia 3310 LCD
displays at time of writing include www.jelu.
se and gsmserver.com, although I have no
experience with either source.
siliconchip.com.au
CIRCUIT NOTEBOOK
Interesting circuit ideas which we have checked but not built and tested. Contributions from
readers are welcome and will be paid for at standard rates.
UHF IN
300
BR2
3.6k
+
TUNING
2.2 F
IFo
AFC
BL
AGC
BH
BU
TUNING
TUNER MODULE
UVE 33–12
VHF IN
75
VR1
10k
+42V
+
–
470 F
63V
~
BR1
VHFL
BAND
SELECT
S1
2.2 F
VHFH
A
UHF
1nF
D1,D2: 1N4148
A
A
VR3
10k
SENSITIVITY
9V
AC
~
This TV field strength meter is
based on a tuner module salvaged
from an old Sharp TV although the
circuit can be adapted to most VHF/
UHF tuner modules used in TVs
and VCRs. The pin assignments are
usually stamped on the cover of the
tuner module or may be found on
the bottom of the PC board.
The Sharp tuner is an older model
digital tuner, with a 75-ohm input
for VHF and a 300-ohm input for
UHF. Modern tuners now have a
single 75-ohm input for the VHF &
Q1
PN100
100–200 A
+
–
METER
VR3
10k
B
+12V
METER
–
+
C
100–200 A
E
OPTIONAL MOD FOR MORE SENSITIVITY
K
TV field
strength meter
240V
AC
–
VR2
10k 1000 F
16V
K
K
D1
C B E
30V
AC
D2
PN100
S2
T1
~
+
+12V
GAIN
~
UHF bands. Old VCRs can be picked
up cheaply at flea markets and at
kerbside rubbish collection times.
The IF (intermediate frequency)
pin produces a 45MHz signal (in the
USA) and the IF output level varies
with the incoming signal level. In
fact, the frequency of the IF signal
doesn’t matter as it’s simply rectified
by diodes D1 & D2. Trimpot VR3
provides a sensitivity adjustment
for the meter.
The circuit is powered by a
transformer with 8V and 30V AC
secondary windings. The 8V AC is
rectified by bridge BR1 and filtered
to provide the nominal 12V DC rail
for the tuner module while the 30V
AC is rectified by bridge BR2 and fed
to potentiometer VR1 is to provide
a tuning voltage range of 0-30V DC.
Potentiometer VR1 is connected to
the AGC input to serve as a gain
control.
If you need more gain to obtain
reasonable deflection of the meter, transistor Q1 can be added, as
shown.
As presented, the circuit will give
a useful indication of TV signal
strength and can be used as an aid
for best antenna orientation.
Henry Bowman,
Parsons, Tennessee. ($50)
Contribute And Choose Your Prize
As you can see, we pay good money
for each of the “Circuit Notebook” items
published in SILICON CHIP. But there are
four more reasons to send in your circuit
idea. Each month, the best contribution published will entitle the author to
choose the prize: an LCR40 LCR meter,
a DCA55 Semiconductor Component
Analyser, an ESR60 Equivalent Series
Resistance Analyser or an SCR100
siliconchip.com.au
Thyristor & Triac Analyser, with the
compliments of Peak Electronic Design
Ltd – see www.peakelec.co.uk
You can either email your idea to
silchip<at>siliconchip.com.au or post it
to PO Box 139, Collaroy, NSW 2097.
March 2008 67
D. Edw
is this m ards
onth’s
winne
Peak Atl r of a
as
Instrum Test
ent
Circuit Notebook – Continued
S1
100
+5V
10k
K
REG1 7805
OUT
ZD1
16V
1W
100 F
IN
GND
A
2.7k
SET
VOLTS
2
VR1
2k LIN
3 LM311
B
C
8
IC1
47k
7
E
B
4
C
1
1k
4.7k
Q1
BC557
ALTERNATOR
+
F
1k
10 F
+
12V
BATTERY
Q2
2N2955
OR SIM
1M
A
POWER
LED1
CHARGING
LED2
K
GND
–
E
K
A
D1
1N5404
A
–
K
7805
2N2955
LEDS
OUT
IN
GND
BC557
K
A
ZD1
B
E
C
A
C
1N5404
K
Alternator controller for
charging deep cycle batteries
A
K
B
C
E
This controller is used for charging a bank of deep-cycle lead acid
batteries from a 12V alternator
driven by a Lister diesel motor. It
provides three modes of charging:
a hefty initial bulk charge, a pulse
width modulated float charge to
settle the voltage level and, when
required, an adjustable high-voltage
equalising charge. This latter mode
is also useful to reactivate the sulphated batteries.
The heart of the circuit is an LM311 comparator (IC1) and its reference voltage at pin 3 is provided by a
78L05 voltage regulator. The battery
voltage is monitored during charging
by a resistive divider which includes
trimpot VR1. Its wiper is connected
to the non-inverting input (pin 2) of
the LM311. If the battery is below
the set reference voltage level, the
alternator field current is supplied
by transistors Q1 & Q2, setting the
alternator at its maximum charge
current.
When the set level is attained,
nominally 13.8V to 14.2V, the
circuit will switch to PWM mode,
pulsing current into the battery
bank at whatever rate is required to
keep equilibrium. This pulse width
modulation (PWM) is a function of
the hysteresis of the comparator, as
determined by the 1MW resistor between pins 3 & 7. At this point, the
generating system can be shut down,
as the best diesel efficiency can only
be achieved if the engine is running
almost fully loaded.
The battery bank should be equalised several times a year. This is
achieved by setting the cut-out voltage much higher than normal, usually around 15V and charging the
batteries to this level. This will cause
gassing in the cells which helps to
mix the electrolyte which otherwise
tends to settle into layers of varying
acidic density. Any load connected
to the battery bank should be disconnected during this procedure.
D. Edwards,
Taylorville, NZ.
Emergency light
uses 3W white LED
and also prevents reverse current
flow from the battery.
555 timer IC1 functions as an optical comparator and switch. LDR1
is the light-sensing element. When
light intensity is high, LDR1’s resistance is low and as a result, the high
level output from pin 3 will turn on
transistor Q1 and disable the LM317
driving LED1 (in reality, it reduces
the output of the LM317 to 1.25V).
When the light intensity is low,
LDR1’s resistance is high, the 555’s
output switches low and the LM317
is enabled to drive LED1.
(Editor’s note: this circuit has no
provision to prevent over-discharge
of the SLA battery if it is left to run
for an extended period. Discharging
an SLA battery below 1.8V per cell
(ie, 5.4V for a 6V SLA battery) will
destroy it.
T. K. Hareendran,
Kerala, India. ($35)
This simple emergency light is
based on one 3-watt white power
LED. 12V AC is applied to a bridge
rectifier and a 100mF filter capacitor
to feed an LM317 voltage regulator.
This is arranged to deliver 7.5V DC
via diode D1 to charge a 6V 4Ah
SLA battery. Diode D1 limits the
maximum battery voltage to 6.9V
68 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
+5V
1k
100nF
4.7k
4
RESET
RUN
17
15
UP
18
16
DOWN
1
14
+V
IN0
4
OUT3
IN6
OUT2
IN1
OUT1
IN7
OUT0
IC1
PICAXE18X
IN2
OUT7
OUT6
2
*
3
3x
10k
SER.OUT
OUT5
SER.IN
OUT4
0V
5
3
9
6
2
8
1
7
7
6
5
13
16
Vdd
BI
Og
LT
Of
DD
Oe
14
7 x 47
Oc
DB
Ob
DA
Oa
EL
9
9
1
10
f
2
11
4
12
6
13
7
b
g
e
c
Q1
BC557
B
E
C
Q2
BC557
+12V
A
A
LEDS
K
A
K
1N4004
B
BC337, BC557
K
A
RLY1
D1
1N4004
READY
LED2
10k
siliconchip.com.au
c
d
8
E
B
330
K
This PICAXE countdown timer
uses two 7-segment displays to
provide a maximum light box exposure time of 99 seconds. Three
pushbutton switches are used to set
the time (Up/Down) and to start the
exposure (Run).
A default time of 30 seconds is
loaded the first time the software
is run and after that the micro (IC1)
stores the last time that was used,
ready for the next run. The last used
e
4
b
7
C
TIMING
LED1
PICAXE light box
countdown timer
2
g
10k
330
* PROGRAMMING PINS:
SEE PICAXE MANUAL
f
8
10k
10
a
1
6
d
8
11
9
a
Vss
12
DISP2
FND500
10
15
10
IC2
Od
4511B
DC
DISP1
FND500
A
K
setting is saved when the power is
turned off.
Four outputs from the PICAXE
drive a 4511 BCD to 7-segment
decoder (IC2). This drives the two
7-segment displays together with
transistors Q1 & Q2 which drive the
display’s common cathodes.
The timing is controlled by ‘for
next loops’ and the ‘pause’ command. The timer counts down
from the selected time in seconds,
to zero.
There are two LEDs. Pin 11 drives
LED2 (green) to flash at a 1-second
Q3
BC337
E
UV LIGHT
SWITCHING
B
E
C
C
interval to indicate that the timer is
ready. Pin 10 goes high to turn on
LED1 when the timer is counting
down. The same output also drives
transistor Q3 to operate the power
relay to switch the lamps on an off.
The details of the 240VAC mains
wiring can be the same as for the
Light Box Controller in the November 2007 issue of SILICON CHIP.
The software (Countdown1.bas)
will be available from the SILICON
CHIP website.
Cliff Wylie,
Leumeah, NSW. ($50)
March 2008 69
70 Silicon Chip
This simple impedance bridge uses
three twin-T oscillators based on Q1,
Q3 & Q5 which are set to run at 100Hz,
1kHz and 15kHz. The oscillator outputs are taken from the resistive legs
of the twin-Ts via FETs Q2, Q4 & Q6
which act as high impedance buffers
(source followers). The oscillator fre-
quencies can be trimmed by trimpots
VR1, VR2 & VR3.
The oscillator amplitudes are set
by VR4, VR5 & VR6 and fed to switch
S3 before being amplified by IC1, an
LM380 amplifier. This drives transformer T1 which drives the switch
ranges for the bridge circuit.
Impedance bridge measures
at three frequencies
Finally, the null voltage from the
bridge is amplified by the AC-coupled
stages of Q7, Q8 & Q9 before being
AC-coupled to the bridge rectifier (D1D4) and the meter movement. Diode
D5 protects the meter movement from
overload.
In use, the unknown component is
connected across the Z terminals and
the range and multiplier switches S2
& S3 are adjusted to get a null reading
(ie, minimum) on the analog meter.
The impedance is then read off the
switch settings for S2 & S3.
Fritz Winkler,
Bunbury, WA. ($60)
Circuit Notebook – Continued
siliconchip.com.au
REG1 7805
OUT
7
6
470k
8
4
7
3
IC1
555
2
6
5
8
LED3
3
IC2
555
5
330
1 F
330
7805
IN
GND
A
LED2
K
K
A
A
A
2
1
K
Simple Mosfet
tester
This simple tester checks both
N-channel and P-channel Mosfets. It
checks for shorts between gate, drain
and source and also distinguishes
between N and P-channel Mosfets.
IC1 is configured as an astable
multivibrator to run at about 2Hz,
as determined by the components at
pins 2, 6 & 7. IC2, another 555 timer,
is used simply as an inverter. Hence
the two pin 3 outputs of IC1 & IC2
are in anti-phase.
These two pin 3 outputs are fed
out via 330W resistors and LEDs 1 &
S1c
2
1
4
3
D1, D2: 1N4148
A
4
3
D2
LED1
A
K
D1
LEDS
OUT
K
1
K
9V
BATTERY
A
4
2
1
GND
GND
330
4.7k
10k
S2
IN
4
3
2
1
S1b
S1a
SOURCE
DRAIN
GATE
K
2, paralleled with diodes D1 & D2.
From there, the anti-phase signals
are connected to the Mosfet under
test via a 3-pole 4-position rotary
switch. The three switch wipers
are connected to terminals labelled
“gate”, “drain” and “source”.
The switch settings correspond to
the following tests: Test 1 checks for
a short between the gate and source.
If a short exists, alternating current
paths are provided via LED1 and
LED2 (ie, the LEDs alternately turn
on and off). Test 2 checks for a short
between the gate and drain. If there
is no short, no LEDs will light.
Test 3 provides a positive bias to
the gate, while the drain and source
are connected to the LEDs. If the
Mosfet is N-channel, both LED1
and LED2 will blink. If the Mosfet
is P-channel, only LED2 will blink.
Test 4 provides a negative bias to
the gate, while the drain and source
are connected to the LEDs. If the
Mosfet is P-channel, both LED1 and
LED2 will blink. If the Mosfet is Nchannel, only LED1 will blink.
If the Mosfet’s drain and source are
shorted, both LED1 & LED2 will flash
in tests 3 and 4, for both N-channel
and P-channel Mosfets.
Henry Bowman,
Parsons, Tennessee. ($45)
supply connector (use a Y-adaptor
if necessary). The red wire is +5V,
yellow is +12V and the two black
wires are the common/ground leads.
T. K. Hareendran,
Kerala, India. ($35)
PC cooling
fan driver
This circuit can be used to control
a fan in a computer or equipment
cabinet. It’s based on an LM35
analog temperature sensor which
has an output voltage that’s directly
proportional to temperature in °C.
Its output signal is fed to a CA3130
op amp (IC2) which is connected as
a comparator.
IC2 switches on the fan via transistors Q1 & Q2 when the air temperature is above that set by VR1. LED1
lights whenever the fan is running.
Power for the circuit comes from
the +5V and +12V rails in a PC and
can be derived from a spare 4-pin
siliconchip.com.au
March 2008 71
:
IC
2
By JIM ROWE
A Quick
Primer
Developed by Philips over 25 years ago, the I2C bus is now
a well-established standard for low to medium-speed data
communication between ICs. However, its basic operation
still isn’t well understood, except by people in the chip design
business. Here’s a quick primer to bring you up to speed.
B
ACK ABOUT 1980, when digital
ICs were really starting to be used
in consumer gear such as car radios,
stereo systems and TV sets, Philips
developed a low-cost interfacing technique for allowing the various ICs
in a system to exchange data at a
low to medium speed. They called
it the “Inter-Integrated Circuit” or “Isquared-C” (I2C) bus and it rapidly
became very widely used for data
communication between ICs in all
kinds of equipment.
These days, I2C is found not just in
consumer audio and video gear but in
computer and industrial equipment
as well. In fact, it’s now used in over
1000 ICs, made by more than 50 different companies worldwide. So it’s
well worth knowing how this very
versatile bus works.
I2C is usually described as a 2-wire
synchronous serial bus, although
strictly speaking it’s a 3-wire bus
because the PC board’s ground line
is also an essential part of the communications link. The two nominal
wires or “lines” are the data or SDA
line and the clock or SCL line. Both
of these lines are regarded as bidirec72 Silicon Chip
tional and to allow this they are both
used in wired-OR or “open drain/open
collector” mode.
This means that both lines are connected to the PC board’s positive supply rail only via pull-up resistors and
can only be pulled down to logic low
(or ground potential) by the circuitry
inside the chips connected to the bus
lines. So strictly speaking, any chip
connected to the SDA or SCL lines
can pull them down but if none of the
chips does so, both lines are pulled
high by the external resistors. This is
known as the “idle bus” condition,
incidentally.
In its most basic form, I2C is used
for “master-slave” communication –
where one device takes control of the
bus as the master, to send data to or
request data from another device acting as the slave. It’s true that because
both the SDA and SCL lines are bidirectional, any device on the bus can
initiate a data transfer as the master
and similarly, any device can play the
role of the slave.
So the I2C bus can operate as a
multi-master bus and in fact its official specification provides for bus
contention and resolution situations,
where two devices try to take control
of the bus at the same time. However,
in most common applications, there
is a single master device (usually a
microcontroller) and the rest of the
devices are used as slaves. These slave
devices may be digital tuning chips,
controlled-gain amplifier or filter
chips, video switching or processing
chips, EEPROM memories and LCD
panels, etc.
Fig.1 shows the basic master-slave
I2C interface circuit. As shown, there
are really three lines between the
master and slave chips: SCL, SDA and
ground. The external pull-up resistors
(Rp) provide the only connections
between the SCL and SDA lines and
the positive supply rail (+V).
In operation, the SDA line can be
pulled down to ground by either the
master or slave devices, via the opendrain Mosfets connected internally
to their SDA pins. Similarly, both
chips can monitor the logic levels on
the SDA line, via the Schmitt trigger
inverters which are also connected to
their SDA pins.
The circuitry connected to the SCL
siliconchip.com.au
Data transfer
The master device controls all data
siliconchip.com.au
SLAVE DEVICE
Rp
SCL
SCL
CLOCK
IN
DATA
IN
SDA
SDA
DATA
IN
DATA
OUT
GND
GND
DATA
OUT
CLOCK
OUT
FIG.1: BASIC MASTER-SLAVE I 2 C INTERFACE
+V
MASTER DEVICE
Rp
Rp
SCL
SCL
SDA
SDA
GND
SCL
SLAVE DEVICE 1
SDA
GND
SDA
Before an I2C data transfer operation
or sequence can take place, the master
device must check to make sure that
the bus is idle; ie, both the SCL and
SDA lines must be at logic high. If so, it
then takes control of the bus by pulling
down the SDA line while leaving the
SCL line high.
This is described as setting up a
“Start condition” and announces to
all other devices on the bus that a data
transfer is about to take place. The Start
condition can be seen on the left in
the SCL and SDA waveforms shown
in Fig.3(a).
We’ll look at the actual data transfer operations in more detail shortly.
For the moment, let’s look at the way
the master device signals the end of a
data transfer sequence, by setting up
a “Stop condition”.
As shown on the right of Fig.3(a),
this is simply the reverse of the Start
condition. The master device releases
control of the SCL line first, so that it
goes high, then it releases the SDA
line so this also goes high (ie, after
the SCL line goes high). Both lines
are then high, thus returning the bus
to the idle condition.
So this is the basic format of an I2C
data transfer sequence: Start condition, the data transfer itself and then
the Stop condition – all under the
control of the master device.
Now let’s look more closely at the
fine details.
Rp
GND
Starting and stopping
+V
MASTER DEVICE
SCL
pin inside each chip can be identical
to that connected to the SDA pins.
However, if only one device is to act as
the master, it only needs an open-drain
Mosfet connected to the SCL pin (as
shown in Fig.1) because it will always
be providing the SCL clock pulses.
Conversely, when other devices are
only being used as slaves, they only
need the Schmitt trigger inverter to
“receive” the SCL clock pulses.
The next thing to note is that although Fig.1 only shows a master
device with a single slave device, the
I2C bus can be used to connect one or
more masters to many slave devices
– as many as 112 different devices in
fact. These slave devices are simply
connected to the SCL and SDA lines
in “daisy chain” fashion, as shown
in Fig.2.
SLAVE DEVICE 2
2
FIG.2: I C BUS WITH ONE MASTER, MANY SLAVES
transfer on the I2C bus, as this is the
device that toggles the SCL line to
produce clock pulses – one positive
pulse for each data bit, as shown in
Fig.3(b). The data bits themselves are
conveyed on the SDA line, which must
be stable when the SCL line is high.
All logic level changes on the SDA
line must occur between clock pulses,
when the SCL line is low.
Basically, all data is sent over the I2C
bus this way, as serial eight-bit bytes
with the most significant bit (MSB)
first. This is shown in Fig.3(c), which
also shows the next important thing
you need to know about I2C operation:
after each data byte is sent, the receiving device must “Acknowledge” that
it has been received.
This is normally done by the receiver pulling down the SDA line
while the master device provides a
ninth clock pulse on the SCL line.
Which device pulls down the SDA line
to acknowledge reception depends on
the direction of data transfer: if the
master is sending data to a slave, the
slave device must acknowledge. On
the other hand, if a slave is sending
data to the master, the master itself
must acknowledge.
In other words not only is acknowledging mandatory after each byte but
it is the receiving device which must
do the acknowledging. As noted above,
the acknowledge is usually done by
pulling the SDA line low during the
ninth clock pulse, known as “ACK”,
but there are some situations where
the receiving device acknowledges
by leaving the SDA line high. This is
known as “ACK-bar” and we’ll look at
it more closely soon.
Addressing
By now you’re probably wondering
how the I2C master device can selectively communicate with one particular slave device when there may be a
number of slaves on the bus. That’s
easy: the first data byte sent out by the
master after it grabs the bus and sets
up the Start condition is an address
byte, specifying which slave device
March 2008 73
SDA
SCL
BUS
IDLE
(DATA EXCHANGE
& ACKNOWLEDGE)
START
CONDITION
STOP
CONDITION
BUS
IDLE
Fig.3(a): BASIC I 2 C DATA EXCHANGE SEQUENCE
SDA
each device as having two addresses
on the I2C bus – one address for writing data to it and the other for reading
from it. For example, a device might
have an effective write address of say
42h (01000010 binary) and a read
address of 43h (01000011). This is
really the same device address, with
only the final read/write bit changing
in value.
By the way, the current I2C specification also provides for 10-bit extended
device addressing as an alternative to
the 7-bit addressing scheme. However
10-bit device addressing is apparently
not used much yet.
Single byte transfers
SCL
SDA STABLE
WHEN
SCL IS HIGH
SDA CAN
CHANGE WHEN
SCL IS LOW
(NEXT BIT
TRANSFER)
Fig.3(b): DATA (ADDRESS) BIT TRANSFER
SDA
B7
B6
B5
B4
B3
B2
B1
B0
SCL
DATA (ADDRESS) BITS TRANSFERRED – MSB FIRST
ACKNOWLEDGE
BY RECEIVING
DEVICE
Fig.3(c): DATA (ADDRESS) BYTE TRANSFER WITH ACKNOWLEDGE
it wants to communicate with. It also
specifies whether it wants to write data
to the device or read back data from
it. Basically, the first seven bits of this
first byte form the actual slave address,
while the eighth bit specifies a read (1)
or a write (0) operation.
This addressing scheme is part of
the I2C bus specification and devices
designed to communicate via the
I2C bus are given unique addresses
(licensed to the chip maker by NXP,
the current name for Philips Semiconductors). In some cases the address is
built right inside the chip and can’t
be changed, while in others it can be
set to one of a number of addresses
in a range allocated to that device, by
tying one or more of its other pins to
logic high or low.
The latter arrangement is especially
74 Silicon Chip
useful for devices like EEPROMs and
other memories, where you might
want to have a number of them on the
same bus. Each device can be given
its own unique address to prevent
confusion.
Because the I2C address code uses
seven bits, this means that in theory
you should be able to have a maximum
of 128 (27) devices connected to the
same bus. However, as part of the
I2C specification, 16 of the possible
address codes are reserved for either
special or future purposes, so in practice you can only have a maximum of
112 different chips on the same bus.
That’s still more than enough to handle
the vast majority of situations.
By the way, since the read/write bit
effectively forms the eighth bit of the
address byte, it’s quite valid to regard
To make basic I2C operation a little
clearer, let’s now take a look at Fig.4(a).
This shows the sequence of operations
involved in a master device taking control of the bus, addressing a particular
slave device and then writing a single
byte of data to that device.
As you can see, the sequence begins
with the master setting up the Start
condition (S) and then sending the
7-bit address of the slave it wants to
receive the data. It then follows with
zero in the eighth bit (R/W-bar) position to indicate that it wants to “write”
or send the data.
If that particular slave device is
present on the bus and ready to accept the data, it must then respond
by pulling the SDA line low (A) before the master sends out the ninth
(acknowledge) clock pulse. None of
the devices on the bus with other addresses will respond.
Following this acknowledgement,
the master then sends out the eight bits
of the data byte itself, after which the
slave device must respond again with
an acknowledge bit. Once the master
detects this second acknowledge, it
sets the Stop condition (P) to signify
the end of the transfer and release the
bus lines.
Reading a single data byte from a
slave device is very similar. Fig.4(b)
shows the details. Here the master
device again sets up the Start condition
(S) and sends out the 7-bit address for
the slave device it wants to read the
byte from. Now comes the first difference, because in this case it sends
out a ‘1’ for the eighth R/W-bar bit, to
indicate that it wants to read back a
data byte from the slave.
If the addressed slave is present and
ready to send back the data byte, it then
siliconchip.com.au
7-BIT SLAVE ADDRESS
S
B6
B5
B3
B4
B2
B1
B0
R/W
A
DATA BYTE
B7
0=
WRITE
S = START CONDITION
A = ACKNOWLEDGE (SDA LOW)
B6
B5
B4
B3
B2
B1
= FROM MASTER TO SLAVE
B0
A
P
= FROM SLAVE TO MASTER
P = STOP CONDITION
Fig.4(a): MASTER WRITING A SINGLE DATA BYTE TO A SLAVE DEVICE
7-BIT SLAVE ADDRESS
S
B6
B5
B3
B4
B2
B1
B0
R/W
A
DATA BYTE
B7
B6
B5
B4
B3
1=
READ
B2
B1
B0
A
P
A = NOT ACKNOWLEDGE (SDA HIGH)
Fig.4(b): MASTER READING A SINGLE DATA BYTE FROM A SLAVE DEVICE
7-BIT SLAVE DEVICE ADDRESS
S
B6
B5
B3
B4
B2
B1
B0
R/W
A
8-BIT SLAVE SUBADDRESS (STARTING)
B7
B6
B5
B7
B6
B5
B4
B3
B2
B1
B0
B2
B1
B0
A
0=
WRITE
DATA BYTE
B7
B6
B5
B4
B3
B2
B1
B0
A
DATA BYTE
B4
B3
A
P
Fig.4(c): MASTER WRITING MULTIPLE DATA BYTES TO SLAVE DEVICE SUBADDRESSES (IN SEQUENCE)
S
7-BIT SLAVE DEVICE ADDRESS
B6
B5
B3
B4
B2
B1
B0
R/W
A
8-BIT SLAVE SUBADDRESS
B7
B6
B5
B7
B6
B5
B4
B3
B2
B1
B0
B2
B1
B0
A
0=
WRITE
Sr
7-BIT SLAVE DEVICE ADDRESS
B6
B5
B3
B4
B2
B1
B0
R/W
A
DATA BYTE
B4
B3
1=
READ
Sr = REPEAT START CONDITION
A
P
A = NOT ACKNOWLEDGE (SDA HIGH)
Fig.4(d): MASTER READING A SINGLE DATA BYTE FROM A SLAVE DEVICE SUBADDRESS
S
7-BIT SLAVE DEVICE ADDRESS
B6
B5
B3
B4
B2
B1
B0
R/W
A
8-BIT SLAVE SUBADDRESS (STARTING)
B7
B6
B5
B7
B6
B5
B7
B6
B5
B4
B3
B2
B1
B0
B2
B1
B0
B2
B1
B0
A
0=
WRITE
Sr
7-BIT SLAVE DEVICE ADDRESS
B6
B5
B3
B4
B2
B1
B0
R/W
DATA BYTE
B6
B5
DATA BYTE
B4
B3
A
1=
READ
Sr = REPEAT START CONDITION
B7
A
B4
B3
B2
B1
B0
A
DATA BYTE
B4
B3
A
P
A = NOT ACKNOWLEDGE (SDA HIGH)
Fig.4(e): MASTER READING MULTIPLE DATA BYTES FROM SLAVE DEVICE SUBADDRESSES (IN SEQUENCE)
siliconchip.com.au
March 2008 75
Table 1: I2C Timing and Electrical Characteristics
Parameter
Standard-mode
Fast-mode
Fast-mode Plus
SCL clock frequency
0–100kb/s
0–400kb/s
0–1Mb/s
SCL clock low time
4.7 s min
1.3 s min
0.5 s min
SCL clock high time
4.0 s min
0.6 s min
0.26 s min
Setup time, S or Sr condition
4.7 s min
0.6 s min
0.26 s min
Hold time, S or Sr condition
4.0 s min
0.6 s min
0.26 s min
Data setup time
250ns min
100ns min
50ns min
Data valid time
3.45 s max
0.9 s max
0.45 s max
Acknowledge data valid time
3.45 s max
0.9 s max
0.45 s max
Rise time, SCL or SDA sigs
1 s max
300ns max
120ns max
Fall time, SCL or SDA sigs
300ns max
300ns max
120ns max
Setup time, stop (P) condition
4.0 s min
0.6 s min
0.26 s min
Bus free time, P – S cond's
4.7 s min
1.3 s min
0.5 s min
Low level output current
3mA min
3mA min
20mA min
Output low volts (3mA sink)
0.4V max
0.4V max
0.4V max
High level volts, SDA or SCL
Vdd + 0.5V max
Vdd + 0.5V max
Vdd + 0.5V max
400pF max
400pF max
550pF max
10pF max
10pF max
10pF max
Shunt C, SDA or SCL lines
Capacitance for each I/O pin
acknowledges the request by pulling
the SDA line low (A) for the ninth
clock pulse. Then when the master
sends out a further eight clock pulses
on the SCL line, the slave toggles the
SDA line to transmit the data bits back
to the master.
Now comes the second change. Although it’s the master that now has to
acknowledge that it has received the
data byte from the slave, it doesn’t do
this by pulling the SDA line down on
the ninth clock pulse as before for a
normal acknowledge (A). Instead, it
leaves it high for a not-acknowledge
(A-bar). Can you guess why? It’s because this is the only way the master
can indicate to the slave that the
transfer is ending and no further data
bytes need be sent.
Finally, the master ends the sequence as before by setting the Stop
(P) condition and releasing the bus
lines.
Remember that in both Fig.4(a) and
Fig.4(b), all the clock pulses on the SCL
line are provided by the master device.
It also sets the Start and Stop conditions, specifies the slave address and
specifies whether the data byte is to
be written to the slave or read from it.
the I2C specification does allow it to
have multiple secondary or subaddresses. This can be very useful where
a device such as an audio or video
processor chip needs to have many
registers or latches to store its various
control parameters, or in the case of a
memory device, to store the data.
Since a complete second byte can be
used to specify the device subaddress,
this means that a complex device can
have as many as 256 subaddresses (28).
This may sound like more than enough
but some very complex video processing chips do need over 180 different
subaddress registers to store their setup parameters and status bytes.
Fortunately, devices which do have
multiple subaddresses usually have an
additional handy feature: a subaddress
“pointer” register which automatically
increments after each data byte write
or read operation. This allows a master
device to write a string of data bytes
into successive subaddress registers,
or read data bytes back from them,
in a single multi-byte operation. All
it needs to do is specify the starting
subaddress first and then send or receive the data bytes one after the other.
Device subaddresses
Fig.4(c) shows the sequence of operations involved for a master device
to write a number of data bytes into
Although each device connected to
an I2C bus has a single main address,
76 Silicon Chip
Multi-byte transfers
successive subaddresses in a slave
device. As you can see, the sequence
begins as before with the master setting
up the Start condition (S), followed by
the main address of the slave device
which is to receive the data, plus an
R/W-bar bit of zero to indicate a data
write.
When the addressed slave device
acknowledges (A), the master then
sends a second byte specifying the
starting subaddress. Then, after the
slave acknowledges again, the master simply begins sending the data
bytes themselves, one after the other.
The slave acknowledges the receipt
of each data byte and saves them in
consecutive subaddress registers,
starting with the subaddress specified
by the master.
Finally, after the last data byte has
been sent and acknowledged, the master sets up the Stop condition (P) and
releases control of the bus. As before,
all the clock pulses on the SCL line are
generated by the master device.
Reading back a data byte from a single slave device subaddress is similar
but with a couple of noteworthy differences – see Fig.4(d).
As before, the master sets up the
Start condition (S) and sends the main
slave address plus an R/W-bar bit of
zero to indicate a write. Then, when
the slave acknowledges, the master
again sends a second byte specifying
the slave subaddress and waits for the
slave to acknowledge.
But now things take a different
course, because the master now has to
set what is known as a “repeat start”
condition (Sr), to signal that it is still
controlling the bus (note: a repeat start
condition is virtually the same as a
normal Start condition except that
it does not follow a Stop condition).
It then sends the main slave address
again but this time with an R/W-bar bit
of “1” to indicate that it wishes to read
a byte rather than write one.
After the slave acknowledges this
repeated slave address byte, it then
sends back the data byte from the
specified subaddress, toggling the
SDA line as before in synchronism
with the SCL clock pulses from the
master. Following the last data bit, the
master must acknowledge, of course,
but if this is the one and only byte to
be read back the master does so not by
pulling the SDA line low for a normal
acknowledge but by leaving it high for
a NACK (A-bar). This is to indicate to
siliconchip.com.au
the slave that there are no more bytes
to be read back.
Finally it sets up the Stop condition (P) as before, to release control
of the bus.
The sequence of events when the
master device wants to read back a
number of data bytes from consecutive slave subaddresses is very similar.
This is shown in Fig.4(e).
Here the master sets the Start condition (S) and sends the slave device
address first as before, followed by an
R/W-bar bit of zero for writing. Then,
when the slave acknowledges, it sends
the starting subaddress and waits for
the slave to acknowledge again. It then
sets a repeat start (Sr) condition and
again sends the slave device address,
followed by an R/W-bar bit of one to
indicate that data will now be read
from the slave rather than written to
it. After acknowledging (A), the slave
then sends back the first byte of data
from the specified starting subaddress.
When the master acknowledges
that it has received this first data byte
by pulling the SDA line down (A),
the slave continues to increment its
internal subaddress pointer and send
back data bytes from consecutive
subaddresses. This continues until
the master acknowledges the last byte
it wishes to receive in the current
transfer, by leaving the SDA line high
during the ninth clock pulse (ie, A-bar)
rather than by pulling it down as for
the earlier bytes. This again signals
the slave that no more bytes are to be
sent back.
Finally, as before, the last step is for
the master to set up the Stop condition
(P) and release control of the bus.
Other bus events
We have now looked at virtually all
of the events that take place on a basic
“single master/multiple slaves” I2C
interface bus. As most common applications are of this type, you shouldn’t
have much trouble with them if you’ve
kept up so far.
There are also other kinds of I2C bus
events like “clock synchronisation”,
“arbitration” and “clock stretching”
but these mainly come into the picture
with more complex multi-master systems – like 10-bit addressing. For the
most part, you won’t need to worry
about them, so I’m not going to try
explaining them here.
If you do need to find out more about
them, they’re covered quite well in
NXP’s I2C Bus Specification and User
Manual, which can be downloaded
from the NXP website (www.nxp.
com/acrobat_download/usermanuals/
UM10204-3.pdf).
I2C bus speeds
When Philips first developed the
I2C bus, it was only intended for lowspeed operation – up to 100kb/s (kilobits per second). However, over the
years, the I2C specification has been
revised and expanded and nowadays
there are a total of four different allowable bus speed modes.
The original 0-100kb/s mode is now
known as “Standard Mode”, while the
other three modes are designated “Fast
Mode” (0-400kb/s), “Fast Mode Plus”
(0-1Mb/s) and “High Speed Mode”
(0-3.4Mb/s).
Table 1 shows the most important
electrical characteristics of the three
speed modes in common use.
If devices are to be used on an I2C
bus running in one of the higher speed
modes, they must be given SDA and
SCL driver and buffer stages capable
of working at those higher speeds. On
the other hand, a device which does
have higher speed drivers and buffers can always be used on an I2C bus
operating in Standard Mode. In fact,
this backwards compatibility is part
of the I2C specification.
Debugging & troubleshooting
Debugging and troubleshooting of
I2C bus circuits can often be done
by monitoring bus activity using a
dual-trace oscilloscope, with one trace
watching the SCL line and the other
the SDA line. If the scope is arranged
to trigger on a negative-going edge on
the SDA line, it will trigger for each
Start condition.
However, for tracking down more
subtle problems, it may be necessary
to use an I2C debugging program running on a PC, linked into the bus via
a suitable hardware interface adaptor.
This type of program usually allows
you to do things like reading data from
slave device subaddress registers, or
writing data into them to program
device operation “on the run”.
There are various I2C debugging
programs currently available, many
of them designed to work with their
own USB-I 2C hardware interface.
These combined software and hardware pack
ages can be fairly pricey
though – up to hundreds of dollars in
some cases.
Fortunately, for quite a few years
now, Philips/NXP has made available
a freeware debugging program of their
own, called “URD” – short for “Universal Register Debugger”. The current
version of this is v3.12, which can run
on any version of Windows up to Windows XP. It comes as a self-installing
file called URD312.EXE and when it
installs, it also unpacks two PDF files.
These PDF files provide a User
Manual for the program (URDUser.pdf)
and a reference manual (URDLang.pdf)
for its programming language, which
seems to be derived from Microsoft’s
Visual Basic for Applications.
Hardware interface
URD v3.12 is compatible with a
very simple hardware interface which
connects to one of the PC’s parallel
printer ports and comes with a driver
for this type of interface. Elsewhere in
this issue, you’ll find a simple LPT/I2C
interface of this type described, so you
can build one up yourself to use with
the URD program. Together they make
a much cheaper alternative to commerSC
cial I2C debugging packages.
Issues Getting Dog-Eared?
Keep your copies of SILICON CHIP safe with these
handy binders
REAL
VALUE
AT
$13.95
PLUS P
&
P
Available Aust, only. Price: $A13.95 plus $7 p&p per order (includes GST). Just
fill in and mail the handy order form in this issue; or fax (02) 9939 2648; or call
(02) 9939 3295 and quote your credit card number.
siliconchip.com.au
March 2008 77
By JIM ROWE
2
LPT-to-I C
A low-cost
interface for debugging
Tracking down problems in circuits which are programmed via an I2C
bus can be tricky and time-consuming, unless you take advantage of a
debugging program running on a PC. Here’s a low-cost, easy-to-build
printer port to I2C interface designed to work with the Philips/NXP
debugging program URD312.exe.
TO PC
PRINTER PORT
(DB25M)
15
SCL IN
SCL
Q2
17
11
SCL OUT
SDA IN
Q1
9
SDA OUT
18-25
GROUND RETURN
78 Silicon Chip
TO I 2 C
BUS ON
PC BOARD
SDA
BEING
TESTED
GND
Fig.1: the basic
arrangement for
the LPT to I2C
interface. Mosfets
Q1 & Q2 pull down
the SCL & SDA
lines for outgoing
signals from the
port, while the
inverters interface
the incoming SCL
& SDA signals from
the circuit under
test.
J
UST RECENTLY, I was trying to
finish a project which uses a couple
of video-processing ICs that are programmed via the I2C bus. However, I
struck trouble with one chip. For some
reason, it wasn’t responding correctly
to the set-up data I was sending to it
from the project’s microcontroller,
even after I had been through my control program umpteen times searching
for bugs (or programming errors).
Even when I wrote a test program
and captured the I2C bus activity with
my digital scope, I still couldn’t track
down the source of the trouble.
siliconchip.com.au
Fortunately, before tearing out the
last few strands of my hair, I decided
to seek help from the support people
at NXP (formerly Philips Semiconductors) – not only because the chip
concerned happened to be one of theirs
but because it was Philips that developed I2C in the first place. After all, if
anyone should be expert at solving I2C
problems, it should be NXP.
As it turned out, they were very
helpful. An NXP support engineer
promptly sent me an email suggesting
several things to try. Then, when that
didn’t fix things, he suggested I try analysing the problem using a debugging
program running on a PC. Not only
that but he also sent me a copy of the
latest version of their free I2C debugging program (called “URD”), which
they developed quite a few years ago.
The current version turned out to be
v3.12, which comes as a self-installing
package called URD312.exe (more on
this later).
Along with the program, he also sent
a device data register set-up file for the
video processing chip I was working
with, so the URD program could communicate with it sooner. And last but
by no means least, he sent me a PDF
file with the circuit of the original PC
printer port/I2C interface card that the
URD program was designed to work
with, so I could build one up for the
troubleshooting.
That’s pretty good support from
the other side of the world, don’t you
think?
As it happened, the original interface used a 74LS05 chip that I didn’t
have, so I decided to update the circuit
to use devices that are readily available nowadays. And that’s the project
described here – it uses a 4011B quad
NAND gate, a couple of Mosfets and
not much else.
How it works
Like the original NXP/Philips interface, this unit is designed to allow the
URD program to communicate with an
siliconchip.com.au
4
7
TO PRINTER
PORT OF PC
DB-25M
+5V
5
SCL
PULLUPS
ENABLE
S1
IC1: 4011B
10
14
8
IC1c
9
11
IC1d
K
–SCL
100
3.3k
S2
12
+3.3V
3.3k
13
SCL
D1
17
10 F
100n
6
10k
12
15
IC1b
D
A
Q2
G
S
100k
SDA
11
–SDA
3
IC1a
1
K
2
D3
9
–SDA
100
A
23
K
24
GND
D4
A
Q1
S
K
D2
25
D
G
A
100k
Q1, Q2: 2N7000
D1 – D4: 1N4148
A
SC
2008
K
D
G
S
LOW COST LPT –I 2 C INTERFACE FOR DEBUGGING
Fig.2: the complete circuit for the LPT to I2C interface. It’s based on Mosfets
Q1 & Q2, a 4011B quad NAND gate (IC1a, IC1c & IC1d) and just a few other
parts. Diodes D1-D4 are there to protect the Mosfets.
I2C bus on a development board via
the PC’s parallel printer port (LPT).
The basic arrangement of the circuit
is shown in Fig.1.
In operation, the URD program
sends out the SCL pulses in inverted
form via pin 17 of the printer port
(originally used for the SEL-bar line).
So the interface uses this printer port
line to control Mosfet Q2, which is
used to pull down the SCL line of the
I2C bus.
Conversely, the URD program monitors the I2C bus SCL pulses via pin 15
of the printer port, which was originally used for monitoring the printer’s
Error-bar line. As a result, the interface
feeds back the SCL line status to pin 15
via a pair of inverters which function
as a non-inverting buffer.
Similarly, the URD program sends
out data to the SDA line (in inverted
form) via pin 9 of the printer port,
originally used to send parallel data
bit 7 to the printer. The interface uses
this printer port line to control Mosfet
Q1, which is used to pull down the
SDA line of the I2C bus.
Finally, the URD program receives
data from the SDA line (again in inverted form) via pin 11 of the printer
port, which was originally used for
monitoring the printer’s Busy/Readybar line. So, in the interface, we feed
March 2008 79
Parts List
1 PC board, code 04203081, 55
x 61mm
1 male D25 connector, 90° PCmount (CON1) (Jaycar PP0843; Altronics P-3220)
1 10-pin (5 x 2) vertical IDC
header, PC-mount (Jaycar
PP-1100; Altronics P-5010)
1 10-way IDC socket (Jaycar PS0984; Altronics P-5310)
1 250mm length of 10-way rainbow cable
5 EZ-hook test clips, 40mm long
1 4-way DIL slider switch (S1,S2)
1 14-pin IC socket
Semiconductors
1 4011B CMOS quad NAND
gate (IC1)
2 2N7000 N-channel Mosfets
(Q1,Q2)
4 1N4148 diodes (D1-D4)
Capacitors
1 10mF 16V RB electrolytic
1 100nF monolithic ceramic
Resistors (0.25W 1%)
2 100kW
2 3.3kW
1 10kW
2 100W
the SDA line data back to pin 11 via a
single inverter.
So that’s the basic idea of the way
the interface works. Let’s now take a
look at the full circuit which is shown
in Fig.2.
Circuit details
As shown in Fig.2, two low-cost
2N7000 N-channel Mosfets (Q1 & Q2)
are used as the SCL and SDA pulldown transistors. Inverter stages IC1c
& IC1d (part of a 4011B quad CMOS
NAND gate) are used for interfacing
the SCL line, while IC1a is used to
interface the SDA line. The fourth gate
(IC1b) is unused.
Most of the rest of the circuitry is
used to protect Mosfets Q1 & Q2 from
possible damage due to electrostatic
charge build-up on the printer port
lines when the interface is not connected to a PC. That’s the reason for
the 100kW resistors connected from
each Mosfet gate to ground and for
diodes D1-D4. The latter prevent each
gate from being taken more negative
than ground or more positive than the
+5V rail which is used to power IC1.
The 10mF capacitor on the +5V line
provides supply line filtering, while
the 10kW resistor ensures that pin 12
of the printer port is pulled high. This
is a requirement of the URD program
which expects to find a logic high on
this pin of the printer port (originally
used for monitoring the “Out of paper” line).
Switches S1 & S2 can be used to
switch in two 3.3kW pull-up resistors
on the SCL & SDA lines respectively.
This is necessary if the I2C bus lines
on the PC board being tested don’t
already have pull-up resistors.
Note that the interface line marked
“+3.3V” must be connected to the
+3.3V line supplying power to the
I2C chips on the board being tested,
so the interface pull-ups can function
correctly.
As indicated, the interface pull-ups
aren’t needed if the board being tested
is already provided with pull-ups of its
own. In that case, S1 and S2 are simply
left open (and the interface’s +3.3V
lead doesn’t need to be connected to
anything).
Building it
Building the interface is very straightf orward, as all the parts are mounted
on a small PC board coded 04203081
and measuring 55 x 61mm. These
parts include the male D25 connec-
From the publishers of SILICON
CHIP
PERFORMANCE
ELECTRONICS
FOR CARS
NOT A REPRINT: More than 160 pages of new and
exciting projects never published before – all designed
to get top performance from your car.
FASCINATING ARTICLES: 7 chapters explaining your
car – engine management, car electronics systems, etc
ADVANCED PROJECTS: You’ll build controllers for turbo
boost, nitrous, fuel injection and much more!
We explain the why as well as the how to!
Available direct from the Publisher ($22.50 inc postage):
Silicon Chip Publications, PO Box 139, Collaroy NSW 2097. Ph (02) 9939 3295; Fax (02) 9939 2648;
email silchip<at>siliconchip.com.au or via our website: www.siliconchip.com.au
80 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
L CS
18030240
V5+
L CS
AD S
9
10
100
4148
4148
100
100nF
L CS-
tor used to mate with the PC
TO PC PRINTER PORT
printer port.
Fig.3 shows the parts layout.
Install the single wire link
CON1 D25M
first, then install the resistors,
71
51
25
the four diodes and the two
1
9
21
11
1
capacitors. Be sure to orien10k
ADState the diodes and the 10mF
ADSelectrolytic capacitor exactly
as shown.
IC1 4011B
Follow these parts with the
two Mosfets (Q1 & Q2) and
4148
4148
the IC, again taking care to
Q1
Q2
2N7000
2N7000
ensure they go in the right way
100k
100k
3.3k
around. The assembly can then
3.3k
CON2
be completed by fitting the D25
+
connector (CON1), the IDC
V 3. 3 +
header (CON2) and the 4-way
D N G 10 F
S2 S1
DIP switch.
Take care when installing
5x2 IDC
CON2 – the slot in its body
SOCKET
2
I C LEADS
goes towards the bottom edge
Fig.3 (right): install the parts on
of the PC board.
TURN OFF S1 & S2
the PC board as shown on this
Note that switches S1 & S2
IF PC BOARD BEING
layout diagram and in the above
are part of a 4-way DIP switch,
TESTED HAS PULLphoto.
Each
pair
of
external
UP RESISTORS ON
with the other two switches not
leads
from
the
10-way
cable
can
SCL & SDA LINES
used. If you happen to have a
be terminated in a small “EZ2-way DIP switch, this could
hook” test clip as shown in the
+5V
+3.3V
GND
be used simply by fitting it in
lead photo.
SDA
SCL
the two righthand positions
(nearer the 3.3kW resistors).
The 10-way IDC header
(CON2) provides the interface to the supply rail on the board.
program, we are posting a copy of
I2C circuit under test. This allows you
If you’re going to be using the pull- URD312.EXE on the S ILICON CHIP
to make up a test lead cable from a up resistors on the interface, you’ll also
website (www.siliconchip.com.au).
250mm length of ribbon cable which need to connect the +3.3V lead to the If you download this and execute it,
is fitted with a 10-way IDC socket at positive rail of the chips connected you’ll find that it will install on most
one end to mate with the header. Each to the I2C bus – and close interface PCs running Win98, WinMe, Win2000
pair of wires in the cable can then be switches S1 and S2, of course.
and WinXP. When it installs, it also
terminated in a small “EZ-hook” test
On the other side of the interface, loads the driver it needs for commuclip to make the connections to the PC all that’s needed is to plug CON1 into nicating with the interface via the
board being tested.
a printer port connector on a suitable printer port.
PC, either directly or via a short D25MI had no difficulty installing and
Putting it to use
D25F extension cable if necessary. running the URD program on a maThere’s not a great deal involved After that, it’s simply a matter of run- chine running Win98 but it did have
in using the interface, apart from ning the URD program and using it to a problem talking to the printer port
connecting the I2C leads from CON2 check and/or modify the contents of when I installed it on a machine runto the appropriate points on the PC the I2C subaddress registers inside the ning WinXP/SP2. I still haven’t sorted
board you’re debugging. This means chips on the board you’re working on. out that particular problem at the time
connecting the SCL and SDA leads
of writing this article but it may be
to the same lines on the board to be Obtaining the URD program
part of the tighter security enforced
tested, the ground lead to the board’s
To make it easier for you to get by WinXP when the SP2 patches are
SC
ground and the +5V lead to a suitable the NXP/Philips URD312 debugging applied.
1
2
Resistor Colour Codes
o
o
o
o
o
siliconchip.com.au
No.
2
1
2
2
Value
100kW
10kW
3.3kW
100W
4-Band Code (1%)
brown black yellow brown
brown black orange brown
orange orange red brown
brown black brown brown
5-Band Code (1%)
brown black black orange brown
brown black black red brown
orange orange black brown brown
brown black black black brown
March 2008 81
Battery-powered aircraft creates
aviation and technology history
“Powered” Flight!
T
wo days before Christmas, a light aircraft took off
from the Aspres sur Brec airfield near Gap in the
French High Alps and flew for more than 50km
without using a drop of petrol or avgas.
It was the first flight of a fixed-wing, piloted plane
powered only by battery and electric motor. The plane,
named the “Electra”, was a single-seater Souricette woodand-fabric aircraft, built from a kit and modified for the
purpose. It was fitted with a British-made 25hp electric
motor (of the type used in golf carts) and 48kg of lithiumpolymer batteries.
With test pilot Christian Vandamme at the controls, it
flew a course through The Alps for 48 minutes.
While electric-powered flight has been achieved before,
it was either with ultralights, powered hang gliders or pilotless drones. In fact, SILICON CHIP featured such a flight
more than fifteen years ago – in the October 1991 issue.
And US inventor Paul MacCready, who developed the
first man-powered plane, the Gossamer Albatross, has
also pioneered electric-motor-powered microlights and
ultralights, including a flight over the English Channel
in 1981.
However, a fixed-wing, conventional
plane (one with an airworthiness cerby ROSS
tificate) flying with only battery power
82 Silicon Chip
has until now been a dream.
A group founded to promote electric/green flight, the
French “APAME” group, (rough translation Association
for Promotion of Electric Aircraft), was behind the project, in collaboration with ACV Aero Services, Pegase,
Capenergies and Onera.
President of APAME, Anne Levrand, said that the flight
showed that non-polluting, quiet, light aviation was
within reach. “Fuel cost per hour of the Electravia was
around one Euro, compared with about 60 Euro for an
equivalent petrol-driven aircraft,” she said. “The motor
and batteries will cost between ten and fifteen thousand
Euro, roughly the same as current small petrol engines.”
However, this comparison has started fierce debate
amongst green and aviation groups, who maintain that
when you take the cost and environmental impact of the
batteries into account (especially the lithium) and then
look at factors such as performance, petrol still wins
hands-down.
The debate highlights one of the major hurdles in electricpowered anything – but most importantly aircraft – the
weight and weight-to-power ratio of the
batteries. Typically, batteries produce
just 2% of the energy of the same mass
TESTER
of petrol.
siliconchip.com.au
Some technical data:
Aircraft:
“ELECTRA” registration no F-WMDJ :
One-seater
Kit construction, in wood and fabrics
Wing span : 9m
Length : 7m
Weight of the aircraft without batteries: 134kg
Maximum weight for take off : 265kg
Cruise speed : 90km/h
Special ground-adjustable propeller from ARPLAST
Electrical:
Motor: 18kW disk brush type
Batteries: Lithium - Polymer
Total weight of batteries: 47kg
Quick charge: 45 minutes
And while huge reseach budgets in the battery field are
currently producing exciting results (see the feature in
the next issue of SILICON CHIP), they are still a long way
behind the internal combustion engine.
Moreover, with current and even foreseeable technology,
battery power can only result in propeller-driven aircraft
with all their current disadvantages over jet aircraft.
But this flight demonstrates that electric flight is possible.
The Times of London reported that Sonex, a leading US
manufacturer of kit aircraft, is about to fly a 50hp electric
plane that can carry two people at 220km/h for up to an
hour before recharge.
This puts the aircraft right into the recreational pilot
market where modest-performing, light sport aircraft are
in demand.
The Times also reported that NASA and Boeing are
currently researching hydrogen-fed fuel cells which will
drive high performance and high power electric motors,
capable of powering much larger aircraft for much longer
SC
flights.
Earlier
successes...
Electric
Ultralight
Trike
On August 25th 2007, the ultralight trike called “Electron Libre” (it means “free electron”!), powered by a 20hp
electric brush motor and supported by APAME and ACV
Aéro Service, performed a 22 minute flight in calm atmosphere conditions from Aspres sur Buëch airfield (Alpen).
New powerful LIPO batteries allow such a performance.
Of course the trike is almost noiseless. Flight with electric
motor is now possible and affordable by all.
siliconchip.com.au
March 2008 83
Vintage Radio
By RODNEY CHAMPNESS, VK3UG
The batteries used to
power vintage radios
This view shows an
assortment of old Eveready
1.5V cells and batteries,
together with a 3V battery
at far right. A Burgess 4.5V
battery is also shown.
Many valve radios were battery-powered
but a lot of the battery types used are now
obsolete and no longer available. However,
with a little ingenuity, sets that would
otherwise be static displays only can be
restored to full working order.
W
HEN WE STOP to think about
it, our civilisation would almost
grind to a halt without batteries. Without them, there would be no iPods, no
mobile phones, no handheld remote
controls, no torches, no hearing aids,
no battery-powered radios, no cordless
mice or keyboards and no cordless
telephones, to name just some of the
equipment we now take for granted.
Even worse, we would have to handcrank our cars to start them if we didn’t
84 Silicon Chip
have batteries to do the job for us!
Batteries were used to power many
early valve radio receivers, particularly in areas where mains power was
unavailable. These batteries consisted
of both primary (non-rechargeable)
and secondary (rechargeable) types. A
primary battery is one that uses up its
chemicals in an irreversible reaction
and is disposed of after use (ie, after it
has gone “flat”). By contrast, secondary batteries can be recharged because
the chemical reactions that take place
inside them are reversible.
Primary cells
Many types of primary cells had
been developed by the early 20th
century. These included the Fuller
bichromate cell, Edison cell, Grenet
Bichromate cell, Bunsen cell, Daniell
cell, Gravity cell, Daniell gravity cell,
Grove cell, Poggendorff cell, silver
chloride cell, air depolarised cells
and last but not least, Leclanche cells.
Many of these cells were a variation
on a theme and all were an attempt to
provide electrical energy in an economical and convenient way.
Because quite corrosive chemical
solutions were used in many of these
cells, considerable care was necessary
when handling them. In fact, none of
these cells were convenient to use in
radios in their original format. However, the Leclanche cell was eventually
modified to give us the now familiar
“dry cell”. This is now the most common primary cell used in portable
radios.
Typically, a Leclanche dry cell has a
positive carbon pole contained in a porous container filled with manganese
dioxide which acts as a depolariser
(the depolariser is used to remove the
hydrogen gas that is developed on the
carbon pole). This assembly stands in a
container of ammonium chloride paste
which also includes a negative zinc
pole. It produces an output voltage of
nominally 1.5V.
One of the accompanying photos
shows three glass-encased cells. The
front one is an early Leclanche cell.
However, we are more familiar with
the normal torch cell in the same photograph, which is basically a refined
version of the Leclanche cell and is
much easier to use.
Secondary cells
By contrast with primary cells,
secondary cells are a more recent
development which occurred around
siliconchip.com.au
Dry batteries designed to power valve radio sets came in all
shapes and sizes. The units shown here are now all obsolete.
1800. However, practical cells did not
become available until about 1880.
As stated above, secondary cells are
rechargeable and include lead-acid
car batteries and the nickel-cadmium
(nicad) and nickel-metal hydride
(NiMH) cells now used in many
electronic devices. Because they are
rechargeable, they can significantly
reduce long-term battery costs in many
applications. Early secondary cells
include Plante cells, Faure cells and
alkaline cells, with quite a few variations on a theme.
During the early 20th century, secondary cells were classified according to their construction as follows:
lead sulphuric acid cells, lead-zinc
cells, lead-copper cells and alkaline
zincate cells. The lead-acid cell is
now the main secondary cell used in
the automotive industry, while NiFe
cells (nickel and iron electrodes) and,
more recently, nickel cadmium cells
are the main alkaline-based electrolyte
secondary cells commonly in use.
Maintenance
Rather than being discarded, early
primary cells were refurbished. The
elements that were used up in the
chemical reactions were replaced,
after which the cell was again ready
for use. However, this was a messy
and quite often expensive exercise.
Furthermore, the chemicals could be
quite corrosive, so care was essential.
siliconchip.com.au
Almost without exception, primary
cells now are thrown away when they
become exhausted. Chinese “D” cells
may cost from 25 cents upwards while
high-quality alkaline cells may cost in
the region of $2.00 each but will give
superior service.
It’s also interesting to note that
some attempts were made to recharge
primary cells back in the 1950s and
early 1960s. During that era, a number of portable radio manufacturers
installed a “re-activation” circuit into
their radios. When the portable was
connected to the mains, the set would
work directly off the mains and the
supply circuitry would also be used
to “recharge” the installed dry
batteries.
In practice, various protocols had to be followed to
recharge the batteries and the
number of recharges the batteries could successfully take was
decidedly vague. Usually, the
instructions were not to use the
batteries in the set to the point
of being completely discharged
before plugging the set into the
mains again. Even four to five
semi-successful “recharges” was
considered good value, as the batteries
were quite expensive.
HMV recommended that the batteries in their sets be “re-activated” for
six hours for every hour of operation.
They believed that a set was typically
used for around two hours a day, so
an overnight charge would be the most
convenient way of doing this.
However, HMV also inferred that the
batteries must be reactivated as soon as
possible after any discharge, otherwise
recharging would not be successful.
Apparently, using the batteries on
successive days without reactivation
would make later attempts futile.
I have no idea as to whether this idea
would work with today’s dry cells,
including alkaline types. However,
High-discharge testers like this
unit were used for checking
lead-acid cells. The battery is
shown for size comparison.
March 2008 85
Another handy test tool was the
hydrometer, used to test the specific
gravity of the electrolyte in leadacid cells.
An assortment of transistor radio batteries. These are mainly 9V types, the
main exception being the 2510 at right which had 2 x 7.5V outputs.
the instructions on many of these
batteries indicate that it should not
be attempted. Perhaps this is because
people may endeavour to recharge the
cells at too high a rate which could
cause them to explode. You have been
warned!
During in the 1960s and 1970s,
Astor and AWA also made some
portable-cum-car radio transistorised
receivers that used rechargeable nicad
AA cells. These sets were rather advanced for their time and they were
fairly expensive.
Secondary cell problems
A disadvantage of early lead-acid
secondary batteries was that it was
necessary to keep an eye on the
charging procedure. This involved
using hydrometer to check the charge
condition of each unsealed lead-acid
cell. A high-discharge cell tester was
also commonly used with car batteries.
During this procedure, it was very
important not to smoke or create any
sparks. This was to prevent the hydrogen gas given off during charging
from exploding. It’s a warning that’s
still valid today.
Early valve radios
Early valve radios commonly used
the 201 or the later 201A triode valves.
These required filament voltages of 5A
at 1A and 5V at 0.25A respectively.
In practice, these valves were
commonly run from a 6V lead-acid
battery with a rheostat in series with
the filaments to reduce the applied
voltage to 5V.
By contrast, the high-tension (HT)
voltage for the 201 & 201A varied
from around 22.5V to about 135V,
depending on the valve’s function in
the circuit. The HT current drain was
usually less than 25mA for the entire
receiver.
In the early days, miniature leadacid batteries were sometimes made
up to supply the HT requirements of
such receivers. Just imagine a bank of
60 cells supplying 120V to a receiver,
then imagine having to check the electrolyte in each of these cells each time
they had to be charged! That would
really have been fun!
I have only ever seen one example of
these miniature batteries so I suspect
that they weren’t all that popular.
An alternative involved using a bank
of dry cells to provide the necessary
HT voltage and current for the receiver.
For a 135V HT rail, this involved connecting 90 cells in series.
It’s worth noting here that dry cell
manufacturers standardised on the
size of the cells used in their batteries
at an early stage. For the HT batteries, they used A-size cells which are
smaller than C-size cells. We don’t
see them around these days but one
is shown in the lead photo, standing
alongside the cyclindrical No.6 cell.
Dry cell deficiencies
Eveready made a wide range of dry batteries for valve radios, the larger “B”
units shown here delivering 45V. Diamond also made a range of dry batteries.
86 Silicon Chip
Unfortunately, early dry cells did
have some deficiencies. First, the insulation used between the cells in a
battery was commonly cardboard and
in a moist environment this became
slightly conductive. As a result, the
batteries would discharge and go flat
over a period of several months, a
problem that was particularly evident
in hot, humid areas.
In addition, some early dry cells had
a “breather” vent and the moisture in
the paste-type electrolyte evaporated
over a period of several months. As
a result, early dry cells had a rather
limited shelf life.
The earliest Traeger pedal radios (for
the Flying Doctor Service) were commonly used in tropical areas and in an
endeavour to overcome the discharge
siliconchip.com.au
A Clyde 2V lead-acid cell (circa
1930s-40s) is shown here, together
with a Leclanche cell at the front
and two Edison cells at right.
problems in dry cells, only 9V of HT
was used from two 4.5V batteries.
The Australian army also initially
had problems with dry batteries in
their transceivers in the tropics during WWII. However, they were able
to reduce the problems by completely
sealing the batteries in wax. Of course,
cost was not of prime concern in that
instance.
Dry batteries have changed enormously over the years and today’s
batteries are considerably better than
those used during the early valve
radio era. In particular, the layer type
method of construction was a major
advance in packaging and was coupled
with good insulation techniques and
economy of manufacture. The subminiature overseas-made HT batteries,
the Australian 490P & 482 types and
transistor receiver batteries such as
the 2761, 2362, 2510, 2364, 216 and
286, etc, all used this very efficient
construction method.
When Australian manufacture of
transistor radios ceased, most of the
“specials” for the Australian receivers quickly became hard to get and
in some cases disappeared from the
market. The 276P “evolved” and became a lower grade battery. The layer
construction was dispensed with and
six “C” cells in a holder were incorporated in its place. This was a backward
step, as the contacts in the holder
didn’t always make good contact and
the electrical capacity of the battery
was reduced.
By contrast, large low-voltage dry
batteries did not depart from the original concept of wiring multiple A, C, D,
E & F cells in parallel (I’ve never found
any reference to a “B” cell). An advantage here was that insulation was not
a problem with such low voltages. We
are all familiar with the “C” and “D”
cell sizes and the “A” was basically a
little brother to the “C” cell. Batteries
such as the X250 and 745 1.5V types
used the “F” cell.
Towards the end of the valve era,
siliconchip.com.au
A collection of
Stanmor dry
batteries. There
was nothing
fancy about the
packaging used
for these units.
portable receivers often used a combined low-tension (LT) and HT battery
in the one case. Apparently, the HT
sections were of layer construction
while the LT sections were built using
“D”, “E” or “F” cells.
One such battery was the 759 which
supplied 1.5V and 90V. This was
suitable for household sets but was
too big for portables. Another battery
pack for use in rural areas was made
by Eveready and contained one X250
1.5V battery and two 470 22.5/45V
batteries. Although they were not all in
the same case, they were all supplied
together in the same delivery carton.
Of course, using an “all in one”
meant that if one section failed, the
whole battery had to be replaced.
Lead-acid batteries were predomin
antly used for supplying valve heaters
and for powering vibrator HT power
supplies. In practice, 2V cells varied
from 25Ah capacity to 130Ah, while
6V batteries varied between 60Ah
and 160Ah in capacity. In 1937, these
March 2008 87
Diamond made a large variety of dry batteries for valve radios, including
45V “B” batteries and 4.5V and 1.5V “A” batteries.
varied in cost from about 17/6 ($1.75)
to about £5/11/6 ($11.15). At that time
the average weekly wage was about
£4/10/- ($9.00), so they were quite
expensive.
The use of 2V lead-acid cells
declined quite rapidly when 1.4V
filament valves were introduced,
replacing those with 2V filaments.
However, 6V (and occasionally 4V)
lead-acid batteries remained in use
with vibrator-powered receivers until
around the mid 1950s.
Battery life
Most radio batteries were rated for
a 20-hour discharge rate. In practice,
a typical 5-valve receiver using 2V
valves draws 720mA. This meant
that a fully-charged 25Ah cell would
need recharging after about 35 hours,
whereas a 130Ah cell would operate
for about 180 hours.
Similarly, vibrator-powered radios
with efficient power supplies typically
drew around 1A from a 6V battery.
That makes the maths simple – a 60Ah
battery would last around 60 hours
and a 160Ah battery would last around
160 hours.
As with lead-acid batteries, dry battery life depends on the battery capac-
ity, the current drawn and the amount
of time that current is drawn during
each listening session. In practice,
the battery life in transistor receivers
varies from around 30 hours for a 9V
216 battery to about 300 hours for a
276P battery and up to 1000 hours for
a 286 (as quoted by Kriesler for one of
their sets).
In typical valve portable receivers,
the life of a 1.5V 745 battery allied with
a pair of 45V 482 batteries was usually
somewhere around 300 hours. The
Australian “miniature” portables used
two 950 cells to provide the filament
current and a 467 67.5V battery to supply the HT current. In operation, the
two 950 cells would last around 30-40
hours, while the 467 HT battery would
probably last up to twice as long.
By the way, if a restorer aimed to
power the filaments of such a set from
“D” cells, a pair of alkaline cells would
give up to 150 hours before dropping
to the cut-off voltage of 1V.
The much larger dry battery packs
designed for household receivers
would have lasted much longer than
the 745/482 combination. In fact,
some combinations may have had an
operational life of around 1000 hours
or more. However, I have no means
of being entirely sure of these figures
(or the other figures quoted above), as
I haven’t actually put this to the test.
Battery receiver power
Providing battery power for early
portable transistor receivers is not
Valve radio
batteries were
typically quite
large and were
not cheap.
88 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
an impossible task. For example, 216
batteries are still used in many transistor receivers and myriads of other
electronic devices. They can often
be used in transistor receivers where
much larger batteries were originally
specified.
Of course, the life of the 216 will be
noticeably less than the battery it is
replacing. The 276P was a commonly
used battery but is rarely seen these
days. However, WES Components
in Ashfield NSW have 276 batteries
with adaptors to convert them to the
276P type.
Alternatively, you can often use several AAA, AA, C or D cells in multiple
cell battery holders if a 216 or a 276
battery is not appropriate.
Battery-powered console, table and
mantel radios that used 2V accumulators and three 45B dry batteries in
series are a different story, as suitable
batteries are no longer made. However,
such sets can be operated from a mains
power supply that’s been designed to
deliver the necessary DC rails at the
required current.
Another way of powering such sets
is via DC-to-DC inverters. These are
typically designed to work from a 6V
or 12V lead-acid battery. This method
is closer to the original method of
supplying power, as the receiver is
independent of the mains.
Valve portable receivers
Valve portable receivers provide a
much greater challenge. Certainly, a
mains type power supply will do the
job but this means that the set can no
longer be used as a portable.
A cumbersome method of supplying
the HT voltage is to string together the
requisite number of 216 batteries. Ten
9V batteries in series to supply 90V
does look a bit odd though! Similarly,
alkaline D cells can supply the filament voltage quite easily.
A better method of supplying the HT
rail is to use a DC-to-DC inverter that
will fit inside the receiver. However,
this can be quite a challenge with the
small miniature receivers of the late
1940s, although the full-sized portables shouldn’t pose too many problems. The filament supply can still be
supplied by heavy-duty alkaline cells,
with the inverter supplying just the HT
requirements of the receiver.
Supplying bias to battery sets is
comparatively easy as no current is
usually drawn from these supplies.
siliconchip.com.au
Typical Eveready Battery Types For Valve & Transistor Radios
Type
Voltage
Comments
Bias Batteries
794
9V
714
4.5V
W95
9V
761
4.5V
Tapped bias battery
Battery to suit “baby” pedal radio
Bias battery tapped at -1.5, -3, -6 & -9V
Bias battery tapped at -1.5, -3 & -4.5V; uses 3 ‘D’ cells, 100 x 35 x 87mm
Low-Tension Batteries
X250
1.5V
30 x ‘F’ cells; companion to the older and larger 470
745
1.5V
8 x ‘F’ cells, 270 x 34 x 97mm
739
9V
717
7.5V
Battery for series-wired portable set filaments; uses 6 x ‘F’ cells
Filament battery; 5 x ‘C’ cells
–
1.5V
Large battery; same size as the 45V 770
High-Tension Batteries
467
67.5V
45 layer type cells; 72 x 34 x 90mm
482
45V
Layer type construction; 90 x 43 x 138mm
470
45V
Large 45V battery, newer type; 126 x 100 x 148mm
770
45V
Large 45V battery, 22 times the volume of the 467
Transistor-Radio Batteries
286
9V
2 x 276P batteries in parallel, 62 x 50 x 180mm
276P
9V
62 x 50 x 90mm
733
9V
57 x 52 x 90mm
2362
9V
33 x 25 x 76mm plus terminals
2364
9V
216
9V
2761
9V
2582
2 x 6V
2510
2 x 7.5V
2512
2 x 9V
Miniature transistor battery
General Purpose Batteries
742
1.5V
4 x ‘F’ cells
509
6V
4 x ‘F’ cells
X-71
1.5V
1 x ‘F’ cell
703
4.5V
Bias and general purpose battery
–
3V
A
1.5V
2 x ‘E’ cells cycle battery
Small general-purpose cell
C
1.5V
Small general-purpose cell
D
1.5V
Medium general-purpose cell
E
1.5V
Medium general-purpose cell
F
1.5V
Medium general-purpose cell
6
1.5V
Large telephone & general purpose cell; 17-30Ah capacity, depending
on use
Composite Batteries
759
1.5V & 90V
Sometimes, the original batteries in
30-50 year old receivers still supply
nearly the correct bias voltage (they
will not supply any current though).
Basically, it’s just a matter of using
suitable small batteries to do the job
(AAA or 216-size batteries may suit
individual receivers).
March 2008 89
Photo Gallery: AWA Empire State Radiolette
PERHAPS THE MOST FAMOUS RADIO made by AWA, the “Empire State” Radiolette was first produced in 1934.
It was housed in a bakelite case and came in a variety of colours including black, brown, marbled white and dark
green. A black Model 28 (1934) and a marble Model 32 (1936) are shown here. Both are 5-valve superhet receivers
and the valve line-up was as follows: 6D6 RF amp, 6A7 converter, 6B7 IF/AF amplifier/detector, 42 audio output and
80 rectifier. Photo supplied by the Historical Radio Society of Australia Inc (HRSA), PO Box 2283, Mt Waverley, Vic
3149. www.hrsa.net.au
Most portables use 1.5V, 7.5V or 9V on
the filaments, while the HT requirement is usually either 67.5V or 90V.
Obtaining a battery eliminator
An assortment for bias batteries from Eveready, Diamond and Impex. Note
the multiple output terminals on each battery, to enable the correct bias
voltage to be selected.
A mains power supply or a DC-toDC inverter supply can also be used to
power non-portable battery-operated
valve radios. This should be relatively
straightforward, as space is not usually
a problem in such sets.
90 Silicon Chip
In practice, a mains supply can
either be designed specifically for particular receiver or designed to supply a
range of voltages to suit many different
receivers from the 1920s to the 1960s.
The same goes for DC-to-DC inverters.
So where do you obtain a suitable
mains-powered battery eliminator to
run a vintage radio? Well, I currently
have a suitable design on the drawing
board to be published later in the year.
This unit will supply filament voltages
of 1.4, 2, 3, 4, 5 & 6V at 1A or so and
7.5-9V at 50mA. It will also supply HT
voltages ranging from 22.5V to 135V
and there will be a good selection of
bias voltages as well.
Suitable DC-to-DC inverters were
rather thin on the ground until Tony
Maher of the Historical Radio Society of Australia (HRSA) designed a
number units in 2001. His first item
was designed to replace a 467 battery.
It fits into the same space as the battery and is powered by four nicad or
NiMH cells.
He has since added a 2V supply
for sets using 2V valves and is about
to publish a 90V version of his 467
battery-sized supply in Radio Waves
SC
(the HRSA in-house magazine).
siliconchip.com.au
Simple add-on board mates with the GPS Frequency Reference
1pps Driver For
Quartz Clocks
By JIM ROWE
This simple add-on module for the GPSBased Frequency Reference is designed
to drive the escapement coil of a low-cost
quartz clock movement. It uses the 1Hz GPS
pulses available at the rear of the Frequency
Reference so that the clock can display local
time with GPS-based accuracy.
I
F YOU BUILT the GPS-Based Frequency Reference described in the
March-May 2007 issues, you’ll know
that it provides a continuous readout
of “Universal Time Coordinated”
(UTC) on its LCD. This time is derived
directly from the GPS satellite system
and is therefore very accurate.
In practice, it’s not all that difficult
to mentally convert UTC into local
time. In most cases, you simply add
or subtract a certain number of hours,
depending on the nominal longitude
of your local time zone and, of course,
your time of year. For example to
convert UTC into Eastern Australian
Standard Time, you simply add 10
hours, or 11 hours during the summer months when we’re on “Summer
Time” (daylight saving). So 05:15:00
UTC becomes 15:15:00 (3:15pm) EAST,
siliconchip.com.au
or in summer 16:15:00 (4:15pm).
That’s all well and good but most
people would find a direct readout of
their local time a little more useful.
And that’s where this project comes
in. It uses the 1pps (one pulse per
second) output from the GPS system
to drive a quartz wall clock. All you
have to do is set the display for local
time at the start, after which the clock
will be accurately controlled via the
GPS seconds pulses.
It turns out to be very easy to interface the GPS Frequency Reference to
a standard ‘analog’ quartz clock movement. First, you have to remove the existing circuitry from the clock (usually
just a chip and a crystal on a tiny PC
board) and bring out the connections
to the clock’s escapement coil. That
done, the coil can be pulsed instead by
the little driver module described here.
This driver module is small enough to
fit inside the clock (next to the movement) and gets its power from the GPS
Frequency Reference, along with the
1Hz (1pps) pulses.
How it works
If you remove the back from a
standard ‘analog’ quartz clock movement and take a look inside, you’ll
find a small PC board with a single IC
chip and a tiny quartz crystal (usually 32.768kHz). This drives a simple
stepper motor coupled to a multi-stage
reduction geartrain.
Inside the IC there’s an oscillator
stage which uses the crystal to generate the 32.768kHz ‘clock’ pulses plus
a counter chain which divides these
pulses down to 1Hz (one per second).
These 1Hz pulses are then used to
drive the movement’s stepper motor
so that it gives an increment of rotation every second. The geartrain then
steps down these increments in the
motor spindle’s rotation to drive the
spindles for the clock’s second, minute
and hour hands.
The stepper motor is basically the
interface between the electronic and
mechanical sections of the clock movement. And that makes the motor quite
March 2008 91
ANTRIM
TRANSFORMERS
manufactured in Australia by
Harbuch Electronics Pty Ltd
harbuch<at>optusnet.com.au
SOFT IRON
STATOR
LAMINATIONS
A
STATOR
COIL
WINDING
B
Toroidal – Conventional Transformers
Power – Audio – Valve – ‘Specials’
Medical – Isolated – Stepup/down
Encased Power Supplies
MULTI-POLE
PERMANENT MAGNET
ROTOR WITH
PINION GEAR
S
S
N
N
(a) BasicN Stepper Motor – At Rest
A
CURRENT
PULSE
B
(N)
Encased Power Supply
9/40 Leighton Pl, HORNSBY 2077
Ph (02) 9476 5854 Fax (02) 9476 3231
This kit makes a great controller for
use on small electric vehicle projects,
such as electrically assisted bikes and
go-carts. We have tested it to over 30
amps without problems—it barely gets
warm! Item code: SPEEDCON.
We also have solar maximiser kits,
Luxeon LEDs, and lots of interesting
products and publications.
Go to shop.ata.org.au or call
us on (03)9639 1500.
92 Silicon Chip
N
A
CURRENT
PULSE
B
(S)
MAGNETIC
FLUX IN
STATOR DURING
PULSE
N
(N)
(N)
N
This controller allows you to vary the
speed of DC motors from 0 to 100%. It
is also ideal for controlling loads such
as incandescent/halogen lamps and
heating elements.
(b) After First 'Odd' Seconds Pulse
S
If you need to control
12 or 24 volt DC
motors and
want a
speed
controller
that will easily
handle 30 amps,
then this is the kit for you.
(S)
S
Want a real speed
controller kit?
(S)
N
Harbuch Electronics Pty Ltd
S
S
www.harbuch.com.au
MAGNETIC
FLUX IN
STATOR DURING
PULSE
(c) After Next 'Even' Seconds Pulse
Fig.1: a clock stepper motor uses a multi-pole permanent magnet rotor which
rotates inside a circular gap in a soft-iron stator. It’s made to step in the same
direction by reversing the polarity of the current pulse at each step.
interesting, especially as it’s surprisingly simple in construction.
In most cases, the motor is similar
to the arrangement shown in Fig.1. As
can be seen, it has a multi-pole permanent magnet rotor which is free to rotate inside a circular gap in a soft-iron
stator. The latter has two pole pieces
which are driven by a single coil.
The trick is to get this very simple
motor to rotate in 1-second steps, all
in the same direction. That’s done by
applying the pulses to the stator coil
with alternate polarity, as shown in
the diagram.
Basically, ‘odd’ pulses are applied
with one polarity, while ‘even’ pulses
are applied with the opposite polarity.
As a result, the rotor clicks around
through an angle equivalent to the
distance between its permanent magnet poles each second – see Fig.1. The
geartrain steps down these 1-second
jumps to drive the clock hands!
siliconchip.com.au
REG1 78L05
+5V
OUT
GND
47 F
16V
100nF
+12V
IN
47 F
16V
0V
(GND)
IC1: 4093B
1pps
INPUT
14
5
8
4
10
9
6
IC1b
100k
IC2: 4013B
Q
CLK
Vdd
13
Q
CLK
R
10
S
Q
IC1d
11
D
Q
R Vss S
4 7 6
6
8
3
10nF
1
CLOCK
COIL
+5V
1
2
7
IC1a
3
7
6
8
3
IC4
555
2
5
10nF
78L05
SC
2008
1PPS CLOCK DRIVER
COM
IN
Circuit details
Refer now to Fig.2 for the complete
circuit details. It can basically be divided into two logical sections.
The first section comprises the
NAND gates of IC1 and flipflop IC2a.
This section separates the stream of
1Hz pulses coming from the GPS Frequency Reference into two streams of
alternating ‘odd’ and ‘even’ pulses.
The second section comprises 555
Semiconductors
1 4093B quad CMOS Schmitt
NAND (IC1)
1 4013B dual CMOS flipflop
(IC2)
2 555 timers (IC3,IC4)
1 78L05 low-power 5V regulator
(REG1)
Resistors (0.25W, 1%)
1 100kW
1 390W
OUT
Fig.2: the circuit uses NAND gates IC1a-IC1d and D-type flipflop IC2a to
separate the incoming 1Hz pulses into alternating “odd” and “even” pulse
streams. These pulse streams then drive IC3 & IC4 which in turn drive the
clock coil.
This means that using the 1Hz
pulses from the GPS Frequency Reference to drive such a clock movement is
quite easy. All we have to do is provide
a simple driver circuit which accepts
the 1Hz GPS pulses and in turn applies
brief current pulses to the stepper motor coil in the same alternate-polarity
manner as the normal clock electronics. And that’s exactly what we do in
this project.
1 PC board, code 04103081, 46
x 38mm
5 PC board terminal pins
Capacitors
2 47mF 16V RB electrolytic
1 100nF monolithic ceramic
(code 104 or 100n)
2 10nF monolithic ceramic
(code 103 or 10n)
4
1
8
390
5
2
2
12
4
IC3
555
1
IC2b
11
7
13
IC2a
5
D
12
14
3
9
IC1c
Parts List
timers IC3 & IC4. These drive the stepper motor coil using the two separated
pulse streams.
In greater detail, the incoming
1Hz pulses are first fed through IC1b
which is connected as an inverting
input buffer. Note that pin 6 of IC1b
is tied to ground via a 100kW resistor
to prevent it from ‘floating high’ if the
input cable is disconnected from the
Frequency Reference.
IC1b’s output appears at pin 4 and is
fed in two directions – to pin 9 of IC1c
and to the clock input (pin 3) of IC2a.
IC1c simply re-inverts the signal and
its pin 10 output is then fed to pin 12
of IC1d and to pin 1 of IC1a.
IC2a is one half of a 4013B dual
D-type flipflop (the second flipflop in
the IC is not used here). As shown, its
Q-bar output is connected back to the
D input, so the flipflop is configured
in toggle mode. As a result, its Q and
Q-bar outputs (pins 1 & 2 respectively)
toggle back and forth in complementary fashion, in response to the incoming pulses.
IC2a’s Q output is fed to pin 13 of
IC1d, while its Q-bar output goes to
pin 2 of IC1a. As a result, IC1d and
IC1a separate the 1Hz pulses into two
alternating streams, each controlled
by the toggling outputs of IC2a. The
‘odd’ 1Hz pulses (inverted) emerge
from pin 11 of IC1d, while the ‘even’
pulses (also inverted) emerge from
pin 3 of IC1a.
These two separated pulse streams
are then used to trigger 555 timers IC3
& IC4 which are used here simply as
inverting drivers. As you can see, the
clock’s stepper motor coil is connected
between their two pin 3 outputs via a
390W current limiting resistor.
During the gaps between the pulses,
both IC3 and IC4 are in their ‘off’
state, with their pin 3 outputs both
switched low. As a result no current
flows through the stepper motor coil.
However, each time a pulse arrives
at IC1b’s pin 6 input, either pin 11 of
Resistor Colour Codes
o
o
o
siliconchip.com.au
No.
1
1
Value
100kW
390W
4-Band Code (1%)
brown black yellow brown
orange white brown brown
5-Band Code (1%)
brown black black orange brown
orange white black black brown
March 2008 93
IC2 4013B
100k
IC1 4093B
IC3
555
390
47 F
+
REG1
78L05
+
+12V
ERJ
1PPS
10nF
CC1
FROM GPS
FREQUENCY
REFERENCE
1PPS
GND
CC2
TO
CLOCK
COIL
IC4
555
100nF
1 8 0 3 01 4 0
10nF
GND
+12V
47 F
Fig.3: install the parts on the PC board as shown in this layout diagram and the photo at right. Take care with
component orientation when installing the ICs and the electrolytic capacitors.
IC1d or pin 3 of IC1a will pulse low,
depending on the current state of
flipflop IC2a.
This causes either IC3 or IC4 to
trigger, pulsing its output pin to the
+5V level for the duration of the pulse
(about 100ms) and hence driving a
pulse of current through the stepper
motor coil in one direction or the
other. The next pulse (about 900ms
later) then triggers the other 555
output driver, resulting in a current
pulse through the coil in the opposite
direction.
Power for the circuit can be derived
from any 12V DC source, including
the 12V DC rail used to power the
GPS Frequency Reference. This is applied to a low-power regulator (REG1)
which delivers a +5V rail to power
the circuit.
The two 47mF capacitors and the
100nF capacitor provide supply decoupling and filtering.
Building the module
All of the driver module circuitry is
mounted on a small PC board coded
04103081 and measuring just 46 x
38mm. This is small enough to mount
in the back of most wall-type quartz
clocks, alongside the movement.
Fig.3 shows the assembly details.
No particular order need be followed
but we suggest that you install the
wire link first, followed by PC stakes
at the five external wiring points. The
two resistors and the capacitors can
then go in. Take care to ensure that the
two 47mF electrolytics are orientated
correctly.
That done, you can install regulator
REG1 and then complete the assembly
by soldering in the four ICs. Be sure
to orientate the ICs as shown on Fig.3
(ie, with pin 1 at lower left) and be
careful not to get IC1 (4093B) and IC2
(4013B) mixed up.
The two terminal pins on the left
marked CC1 and CC2 are used to terminate the leads from the clock’s stepper
motor coil (see below). In addition,
you have to make three connections
to the GPS Frequency Reference – ie,
+12V, GND and the 1Hz GPS pulses.
A length of 2-pair telephone cable can
be used for these connections.
Modifying the movement
It’s not difficult to modify the quartz
clock movement so that it can be
driven by this module. The first step
is to remove the back and then the
clock’s PC board. The latter usually
fits into a slot at one end of the movement’s case. If the battery contacts are
attached directly to the PC board, these
can be removed as well.
As you are removing the PC board,
you’ll find that there are two fine wires
from the stepper motor coil soldered to
it. These two wires must be carefully
desoldered from the board, after which
the board can be discarded.
The next step is to connect a short
length of light-duty 2-core cable (eg,
a 200mm length of rainbow cable)
between the coil wires and the CC1
& CC2 terminals on the driver board.
This should be done in such a way that
neither the joints nor the coil wires
The leads from the clock coil are soldered to two pads on
a piece of scrap PC board as shown in the above photo (see
text). These pads also terminate the leads from the driver
board. The photo at right shows the completed driver
module mounted in the back of the clock case.
94 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
The driver board can be connected to the GPS Frequency Reference via a length
of 2-pair telephone cable fitted with a DB-9 plug. This can plug into a matching
DB-9 socket mounted on the rear panel, just above the “GPS 1Hz” output socket.
will be strained if the lead wires are
accidentally pulled.
The way to do this is as follows.
First, cut a small rectangle from an old
PC board, making it exactly the same
size as the clock PC board (so that it
will slide into same case slot). That
done, cut a 3mm hole into the side of
the movement case near the board slot,
then bring the ends of the lead wires
in through the hole and solder them
to two pads on the new “termination
board”. Finally, solder the coil wires
to these same pads and refit the back
to the clock movement.
The driver module itself can be
mounted next to the clock module.
In our case, the module was attached
to the wooden dial ‘plate’ using a pair
of 6G x 9mm self-tapping screws, with
an M3 nut and flat washer under each
to act as spacers.
GPS reference connections
As mentioned above, a length of
2-pair telephone extension cable is
used to connect the driver module to
the GPS Frequency Reference. To do
this, we suggest fitting an extra DB-9
socket on the rear panel of the GPS
Frequency Reference, just above the
holes for the GPS 1Hz and phase error
pulse outputs – see photo at left.
That done, use three short lengths
of hook-up wire to make the connections inside the unit to three of the
pins on this added socket. One lead
goes from the socket to the main board
ground, another to the +12V line and
the third wire to the rear of the “GPS
1Hz” output socket.
Now fit a matching DB-9 plug to the
end of the cable from the clock driver
module. Be sure to connect the leads
to the correct pins on this plug, to mate
with those on the new DB-9 socket.
It’s now just a matter of testing it out.
Connect the DB-9 plug to the socket,
apply power and check that the clock
immediately starts ticking. Its second
hand should step in time with the
flashes from the “GPS 1Hz” LED on
the GPS Frequency Reference.
All that remains when you get to
this stage is to set the clock movement
to the current local time. If you want
the second hand to read correctly as
well, the easiest way to do this is to
first unplug the clock connection from
the rear of the GPS Frequency Reference when the seconds hand is in the
12 o’clock position.
That done, set the minutes and
hours hands manually for the start of
the next minute and then, as soon as
the UTC seconds display on the Frequency Reference’s LCD reaches “59”,
plug the connection back in again to
restart the clock.
If you time this reconnection correctly, the clock will now display local
time accurately (to the second) – and
will continue to do so as long as GPS
SC
1Hz pulses keep arriving.
“I’ll GO THE RIGOL ... UNBEATBLE FOR PRICE
AND PERFORMANCE”
Rigol DS5062MA 60MHz
Rigol DS5102MA 100MHz
Rigol DS1202CA 200MHz
Rigol DS1302CA 300MHz
60MHz Bandwidth, 2 Ch
1GS/s Real Time Sampling
4k Memory Per Channel
Advanced Triggering
Built-in USB
3 Year Warranty
100MHz Bandwidth, 2 Ch
1GS/s Real Time Sampling
4k Memory Per Channel
Advanced Triggering
Built-in USB
3 Year Warranty
200MHz Bandwidth, 2 Ch
2GS/s Real Time Sampling
10k Memory Per Channel
Advanced Triggering
Built-in USB
3 Year Warranty
300MHz Bandwidth, 2 Ch
2GS/s Real Time Sampling
10k Memory Per Channel
Advanced Triggering
Built-in USB
3 Year Warranty
ONLY $799
Sydney
ex GST
Melbourne
Tel 02 9519 3933
Tel 03 9889 0427
Fax 02 9550 1378
Fax 03 9889 0715
email testinst<at>emona.com.au
siliconchip.com.au
ONLY $1,099
Brisbane
ex GST
Tel 07 3275 2183
Fax 07 3275 2196
ONLY $2,036
Adelaide
Tel 08 8363 5733
Fax 08 83635799
ex GST
Perth
Tel 08 9361 4200
Fax 08 9361 4300
web www.emona.com.au
ONLY $2,620
ex GST
EMONA
March 2008 95
ASK SILICON CHIP
Got a technical problem? Can’t understand a piece of jargon or some technical principle? Drop us a line
and we’ll answer your question. Write to: Ask Silicon Chip, PO Box 139, Collaroy Beach, NSW 2097 or
send an email to silchip<at>siliconchip.com.au
Query on
PC board layout
Looking at the power supply PC
board for the Studio Series Preamplifier (SILICON CHIP, October 2005),
why do the tracks from REG1 & REG2
go to the external terminals first and
then back to D5 and D7? Why don’t
D5 and D7 connect directly to REG1
& REG2, as shown in Fig.10 on page
31? (J. E., Silverwater, NSW).
• This is an interesting question,
J. E., and it highlights the fact that
many aspects of the topology of our
PC board designs never get a mention
in the articles – we simply don’t have
the space.
In this case, notice that diodes D5 &
D7 are in parallel with the 100W sense
resistors for the adjustable regulators
and it is the connections of the 100W
resistors which are important, not the
diodes. By connecting the 100W resistors to the output terminals in the way
depicted, any small voltage loss in the
copper tracks from the OUT pins of the
regulators to the external connectors is
automatically compensated for.
This is a small point, admittedly,
but it does improve the circuit performance. And since the diodes need to
be in parallel with the 100W resistors,
they are connected to the same PC
tracks. Normally of course, the diodes
do nothing.
Puzzlement with
kit assembly
I recently bought a kit for the 20W
Class-A Amplifier from Altronics in
Auburn and have so far put everything
together quite easily. However, there
are a couple of anomalies which I hope
you might throw some light on.
First, the power amplifier circuit
shows a 150nF 250VAC capacitor and
this is also printed on the amplifier
boards (near the inductor). The one
supplied with the kit is marked 150nF
but 100VAC Vishay. Is this a problem?
The hole centres suit the (smaller?)
supplied cap, so I’ve installed it, assuming it will be OK. Can you please
advise?
Ignition System For A 1939 Packard
I bought a High-Energy Ignition
kit (SILICON CHIP, December 2005
& January 2006) for use in a 1939
Packard which is running a 6V
negative-earth system. Can you tell
me if it is suitable for this and if so,
is there anything special I need to
do to make it run?
I built the kit but have had problems with the engine cutting out
after about 10 minutes. This has happened three times, coincidentally
cutting out after running around 10
minutes each time. I have LK1 in the
normal position, LK2 in the 0.5ms
position and LK3 in normal. I have
also tried it in the point’s position.
Are there any bench and in-car
tests I can perform which will help
verify that the circuitry is OK? (S.
L., via email).
96 Silicon Chip
•
This ignition system was not
specifically designed for 6V but
it should work with minor circuit
changes. In particular, the 100W 5W
resistor for the base of transistor Q1
should be 47W 5W instead. Insufficient base current for Q1 when
using the 100W resistor (at 6V) may
be the cause of the cutting out. We
also recommend using a 47W 5W
resistor for the points’ resistor.
One possible problem could be
that the collector is arcing across to
the case. Check that Q1’s collector
(the metal tab) is isolated correctly,
using the washer and bush. Check
that there are no sharp protrusions
that may puncture the washer. The
hole in the box must be chamfered
so there are no sharp edges that can
cause an arc-over.
Second, could you please explain
how to use the tiny little links LK1,
2, 3 & 4 on the preamplifier board
(SILICON CHIP, August 2007, page 20)?
All four supplied in the kit appear
identical. I’ve not encountered this
type of component before and don’t
understand from the instructions
exactly how they’re meant to fit or in
fact, exactly what they do.
The instructions mention the headers have pins but those supplied do
not, just a little sliding socket which
can be pushed out. Is LK2 on top
while LK1 is underneath? Similarly,
is LK3 on top and LK4 below? Your
help would be greatly appreciated, as
I don’t understand the instructions. On
page 18 of the August edition, links
are mentioned and the photo on page
21 shows what looks like a gold pin
sticking up from underneath. (K. P.,
via email).
• The 100VAC capacitor is fine. You
install the four 2-pin headers as shown
on the PC board. Then, the link itself
is the little top sliding section – this
shorts the two pins of the header
together.
Defective brownout
protection
A while back I built the Appliance
Energy Meter (SILICON CHIP, July &
August 2004). I built it with the added
brownout protection but the device
doesn’t seem to restore to normal function once battery operation has been
activated. I have just disconnected the
battery and it seems a waste not to use
the relay. (A. R., via email).
• Make sure the 9V battery is an
alkaline type and is fresh. Standard
9V batteries do not seem to be able to
supply the necessary current.
Better transistors for
the class-A amplifier
For the 20W Class-A Amplifier, is it possible to use MJL1302A &
MJL3281A transistors instead of the
specified MJL21193 & MJL21194 desiliconchip.com.au
Electronic Tacho For A Motorbike
I went to a Jaycar store with the
intent of purchasing your electronic
tachometer. The salespeople allowed me to read the directions/
information that accompanies this
kit but it was not obvious if I could
use the tachometer because the
salespeople and the article were
vague about how the tacho picks up
the signal from the coil.
I want to use it with a Suzuki
DR650 motorbike. As far as I know
it has electronic ignition because
everything does these days. It has
no engine management system and
I doubt that it has electrical connections for adding a tacho.
Any help would be appreciated. I
don’t want to pay about $60 and not
be able to use it. (R. B., via email).
• The tachometer detects rpm signal either from the ignition coil or
from the ignition pickup sensor. In
cars, the sensor is usually a reluctor,
Hall Effect device, optical pick-up
vices? I presume the transistors I have
are genuine On Semiconductor as they
have a circle printed with “ON”. (N.
J., via email).
• Yes, these are ideal substitutes.
Offset problem in
Studio 350 amplifier
I have constructed two Studio 350
amplifier modules (SILICON CHIP, January/February 2004) from kits supplied
by Altronics. For each kit, adjusting
VR1 never brings the output to 0V;
rather it adjusts between 120mV to
10mV from one extreme to another.
Curiously, one kit stays positive with
respect to ground (+120mV to +10mV
over VR1’s range) and the other stays
negative (-10mV to -120mV). With
VR1 in its centre, the offset is about
+35mV in both cases. VR2 adjusts the
idle current just fine.
I have not yet tried removing the
470W set-up resistors and applying
a signal, as I am not particularly
keen on using something that hasn’t
passed its tests. I have checked all the
voltages against those printed on the
schematic in the article and they’re
all within about 20%, although some
only barely.
siliconchip.com.au
or points. With a motorcycle, things
are different and often the ignition
is a very basic Capacitor Discharge
Ignition (CDI) that comprises a high
voltage magneto coil and a magneto
pickup. The high voltage is used
to charge a capacitor which is ultimately dumped into the coil by a
signal from the magneto pickup. A
small electronic circuit comprising
the capacitor and an SCR is used to
dump the capacitor’s charge.
The tachometer can generally be
used if it connects to the magneto
pickup. Although the tachometer
has been used on these CDI motorcycle ignition systems we cannot
guarantee that it will work with all
motorcycles. The tachometer will
not operate on the coil side because
of the short firing pulse from CDI
ignitions.
Note that most motorcycles already include a tachometer as standard equipment.
The power rails measure 72.5V
rather than exactly 70V and I have not
yet hooked up both amplifier modules
at the same time. I am considering
swapping the 2SA1084 transistors
from the long-tailed pair in case they’re
poorly matched enough to cause this
issue. (M. J., via email).
• This is a question of input transistor matching. Try swapping in some
different input transistors to see if you
can get a better match. However, if
you can get the output offset down to
10mV that really is good enough – far
better than most amplifiers. It is really
only important if you are driving a
transformer-coupled loudspeaker such
as an electrostatic.
Short circuit in
NiMH charger
I recently built the NiMH Charger
from the September 2007 issue. It
made all the settings/adjustments OK
with the trimpots but when I connect
batteries (2 x AA) for charging, the voltage regulator (LM317), trimpot VR6
and IC1 all overheat and fail. The DC
power supply is rated for 22V <at> 3A.
My previous Nicad charger projects
from SILICON CHIP are still going strong.
Helping to put you in Control
Controllers
We have a selection of Controllers for
managing your processes.
N322 Electronic
Thermostat
Budget priced ONOFF temperature
controllers. Models
for Thermistor, PT100 RTD and J
Thermocouples. The NTC model is
provided with a 2m waterproof NTC
Thermistor to get you up and running
immediately. From $89+GST
N1100 PID Process
Controller
Popular controller features a universal Input
accepts: Thermocouples , RTD, 4-20mA,
50mV and 0-5Vdc.
Outputs include Relay, 4-20mA and pulse for SSR
From $175+GST
USB I/O Controller
The KTA-220 allows
PC's to control real
world applications. It
features 8 relay outputs, 4 Isolated Inputs, 2 Analog inputs and a PWM
output. Multiple modules can be connected to a single PC. $135 +GST
Serial I/O Controller
KTA-108 is a Serial
Port Controlled I/O
module. It features
8 relay outputs, 4
Isolated Inputs $112.50+GST
Pixel Controller Card
Using the PICAXE 28X
microntroller. It features 8 relays, 8 digital
Inputs, 4 analog inputs. Programmed in
Basic $129.50+GST
Solid State Relays
High quality SSR’s
with 4-32VDC, 80280VAC, 4-20mA and
potentiometer inputs.
DIN Rail and Panel
Mount Heatsinks for
SSR’s also available.
Contact Ocean Controls
Ph: 03 9782 5882
www.oceancontrols.com.au
March 2008 97
Comparing Rechargeable & Non-Rechargeable Cells
I have a question regarding
conventional (non-rechargeable)
batteries versus rechargeable batteries. Just taking standard “over
the counter” cells as an example
(AAA, AA, C & D), rechargeable
cells always come with a mAh rating, whereas conventional batteries
(heavy duty, alkaline, etc) do not. I
know rechargeable cells are 1.2V and
conventional batteries are 1.5V. But
what I’m not clear on is which type
of battery would produce the highest
short-term peak current?
Obviously, if the internal resistances were identical, then 1.5V
would “push” more current into a
given load than 1.2V but is it that
simple? Are the internal resistances
similar in each type of battery?
Why don’t conventional batteries have an mAh rating and why do
some toys say not to use rechargeable
batteries? In my case I am looking at
modifying a launch controller for
model rocketry clustering. Launch
controllers in rocketry are used to
supply current to a Nichrome wire
Circuit board/components checked
OK. Any assistance would be appreciated. (R. R., via email).
• It appears there is a problem with
the LM317. To destroy the adjustment
trimpot and IC1 would suggest that
there is a high current flow in the adjust terminal or the output is somehow
shorting to the drain of the Mosfet.
Check that the Mosfet is isolated from
the box and that the regulator tab is not
shorting to the case with the securing
screw.
Digital instrument
display for fire truck
I want to use the Digital Instrument
Display (SILICON CHIP, August & September 2003) to convert the analog
temperature display on the engine
of a fire brigade truck belonging to a
volunteer brigade, so that I can provide
a remote idiot light at the rear of the
appliance to shut down the engine
in the event of an over-temperature
condition. The problem is that the
vehicle is 24V.
Could you please advise on the
98 Silicon Chip
igniter-head, which in turn ignites
the rocket motor. When clustering
(ie, igniting more than one rocket
motor simultaneously), it is essential
that the controller provides a high
current for a short period (1-3 seconds), otherwise the situation could
arise where one or more motors
may not ignite before lift-off occurs,
which could lead to serious damage
to both the rocket and the pocket, to
say nothing of the potential hazard
to spectators!
This leads to my final question:
for a given number of cells (most
controllers hold four AA cells),
would the best solution be alkalines, rechargeables or the “newer”
non-rechargeable Lithium cells?
Any assistance would be greatly
appreciated.
• Non-rechargeable cells and batteries do not have their capacity
stated because it really depends on
how you use them.
If used for a short time each day,
they will provide more capacity
than if used continuously. The cur-
mods required to run the display from
24V? (J. C., Mt. Dandenong, Vic).
• Change zener diode ZD1 to 30V
rating and the 100mF capacitor at the
input to REG1 to 35V. Change the 1kW
resistor at the collector of Q6 to a 2.2kW
0.5W resistor and make sure C1 and
C2 are 35V.
Serial I/O controller
kit is a slave
I am really keen to build the Serial
I/O Controller kit but there’s one question that has been plaguing my mind
for months now. Is there any way to
interface this card with a computer
and have the card control functions
of software on the computer?
What I am trying to achieve is finding a method of utilising this card to
run batch files on my computer to do
automated tasks should a condition
change on the card’s inputs. Is this
possible? If so, what modifications
would I have to make. (J. H., via email).
• The Serial I/O Controller published
in the November 2005 issue is a slave
device. This means that it sits and
rent draw also changes the available
capacity.
Rechargeable cells state the capacity because this information is
needed to be able to recharge them
and their capacity is fairly consistent
over a wide range of applications.
Some toys cannot be used with
rechargeable cells because they are
voltage sensitive and may not work
well with the lower voltage available
from rechargeables. Rechargeables
can also damage toys with motors
because high current delivered to
a stalled motor can burn it out. In
general, rechargeables can deliver
higher currents than non-rechargeable cells.
The current available from a cell
depends on the chemistry and the
manufacturer. Generally, Nicad cells
can deliver the most current but
these days NiMH cells can deliver
high currents as well.
In general, if you have any device
which can accept rechargeable cells
and you use it a lot, then rechargeables are the better proposition.
waits for commands from the host
PC. Once it receives a command, it
executes it, and optionally sends data
back to the PC. It does not initiate data
transfers with the PC.
The set of commands that are available are explained on page 78 of the
November 2005 issue. For the application that you have in mind, a simple C
program could be written that will run
on the host PC. It would continuously
monitor some condition, by periodically sending commands to the Serial
I/O Controller, and it would analyse
the received data. It would then take
action, such as executing another program, if some condition is met.
In other words, the application you
have in mind can be implemented but
you will have to:
(1) Write a C program (or equivalent in
some other high level language) to poll
the Serial I/O Controller periodically
and analyse its output;
(2) This program must run on the host
PC and must be always running - the
host PC will have to be on for a start.
(3) This program will preferably
be loaded automatically by the OS
siliconchip.com.au
(operating system) and work in the
background.
As you can see, it can be done, yet
the solution is not ideal, mainly because polling is an inefficient way to
implement your application.
PIR Sensor Triggered Mains Switch, February 2008: the O11 output mentioned in the text on pages 58 and 59 and on the circuit should be the O10
output.
Laptop recording
& software
Multi-Message Voice Recorder, December 2007: the resistor from pin 7 of
the HK828 should be 47kW and the parts list should show nine 47kW resistors and only one 10kW.
I was interested in the article on PC
recording (SILICON CHIP, November
2007) as I am about to buy a new laptop
computer for audiovisual work. You
mention the audio testing software
“Rightmark Analyser” but how would
I test a new computer before purchase,
to see if it is suitable?
What are the preferred specs for
a laptop? Few of them appear to be
media-orientated with AV sockets
fitted. My old Pentium 400 had a
separate Pinnacle sound card in one
of the motherboard slots – this had a
full set of RCA in/out connectors on
the rear metal bracket.
I have spoken to four different
computer suppliers and they say that
any late model should do but can’t
be sure. They’re a bit vague, refer me
to someone else or don’t reply. Even
a consultant who specialises in recording has not replied. Yet I’ve seen
concerts being recorded straight into
laptop computers.
Enquiries to the PC user group for
technical specs are for members only.
So maybe I should join then investigate
this recording aspect. (P. S., Albert
Park, Vic).
• Any salesman will tell you that any
laptop will do the job but like anything
else (cars, stereo systems, washing
machines), some are better than others. Some laptops have sound quality
UHF Remote Mains Switch Transmitter, February 2008: Transistor Q1 is
a BC327 (PNP) as listed in the parts list. The circuit labelling is incorrect.
In addition, the parts list should have 5 10kW resistors not 4.
Notes & Errata
Electricity Saving Box, November 2007: the formula published in Fig.6
(page 26) should read: q' = tan-1 (w (L - w2CL2 - CR2))/R = 59.98° which
leads to cos(q') = 0.5.
which is atrocious (hum and noise,
poor frequency response etc) while
others are exemplary – it all depends
on the manufacturer and the model.
Generally, cheap laptops have cheap
and dirty sound circuitry but a high
price is not always a guarantee of
high quality. However, there are a
number of ways of making sure you
get a good one:
(1) Take a copy of the analyser program
with you and ask to test it before you
buy it. Most places will allow this and
if they don’t then try (2) below.
(2) Make sure you get a “money back
guarantee if returned within X days”
deal and simply purchase the laptop.
Take it home and analyse it. If it’s no
good, take it back and demand one
that works properly or you want a
refund.
(3) In the unlikely event that both of
the above are not possible, then get a
high-quality music sampler CD that
you know intimately and a set of highquality headphones – the best you can
get, even if you just borrow them. Play
the CD and listen to it on a known
system of high quality. Then try it on
the laptop in question.
If you have good ears, then it should
be readily apparent if the laptop is
not up to spec – if you don’t, then the
whole matter is rather moot anyway.
Chances are that if the manufacturer
has gone to the trouble of designing
a good audio playback stage in the
laptop, then the recording section will
also be good.
As to what constitutes good specifications, just compare its performance
with that of high-quality amplifiers:
20-20kHz within ±1 or 2dB; less than
0.1% distortion; -70dB hum and
noise or better. There is no need to go
overboard on specifications. The main
thing is that the finished result sounds
good. A poor quality laptop will soon
reveal itself in this regard because
results will simply not be pleasing to
the ear, even when everything else is
SC
done correctly.
WARNING!
SILICON CHIP magazine regularly describes projects which employ a mains power supply or produce high voltage.
All such projects should be considered dangerous or even lethal if not used safely.
Readers are warned that high voltage wiring should be carried out according to the instructions in the articles.
When working on these projects use extreme care to ensure that you do not accidentally come into contact with
mains AC voltages or high voltage DC. If you are not confident about working with projects employing mains voltages
or other high voltages, you are advised not to attempt work on them. Silicon Chip Publications Pty Ltd disclaims
any liability for damages should anyone be killed or injured while working on a project or circuit described in any
issue of SILICON CHIP magazine. Devices or circuits described in SILICON CHIP may be covered by patents. SILICON
CHIP disclaims any liability for the infringement of such patents by the manufacturing or selling of any such equipment. SILICON CHIP also disclaims any liability for projects which are used in such a way as to infringe relevant
government regulations and by-laws.
Advertisers are warned that they are responsible for the content of all advertisements and that they must conform to the Trade Practices Act 1974 or as subsequently amended and to any governmental regulations which are
applicable.
siliconchip.com.au
March 2008 99
ALL S ILICON C HIP SUBSCRIBERS – PRINT,
OR BOTH – AUTOMATICALLY QUALIFY FOR A
REFERENCE $ave 10%ONLINE
DISCOUNT ON ALL BOOK OR PARTSHOP PURCHASES.
CHIP BOOKSHOP 10% (Does not apply to subscriptions)
SILICON
For the latest titles and information, please refer to our website books page: www.siliconchip.com.au/Shop/Books
PIC MICROCONTROLLERS: know it all
SELF ON AUDIO
Multiple authors $85.00
The best of subjects Newnes authors have written over the past few years,
combined in a one-stop maxi reference. Covers introduction to PICs and their
programming in Assembly, PICBASIC, MBASIC & C. 900+ pages.
PROGRAMMING and CUSTOMIZING THE
PICAXE By David Lincoln (2nd Ed, 2011) $65.00*
A great aid when wrestling with applications for the PICAXE
See
series of microcontrollers, at beginner, intermediate and
Review
April
advanced levels. Every electronics class, school and library should have a
copy, along with anyone who works with PICAXEs. 300 pages in paperback. 2011
PIC IN PRACTICE
by D W Smith. 2nd Edition - published 2006 $60.00*
Based on popular short courses on the PIC, for professionals, students
and teachers. Can be used at a variety of levels. An ideal introduction to the
world of microcontrollers. 255 pages in paperback.
PIC MICROCONTROLLER – your personal introductory course By John Morton 3rd edition 2005. $60.00*
A unique and practical guide to getting up and running with the PIC. It assumes no knowledge of microcontrollers – ideal introduction for students,
teachers, technicians and electronics enthusiasts. Revised 3rd edition focuses entirely
on re-programmable flash PICs such as 16F54, 16F84 12F508 and 12F675. 226 pages
in paperback.
A collection of 35 classic magazine articles offering a dependable methodology for designing audio power amplifiers to improve performance at every
point without significantly increasing cost. Includes compressors/limiters,
hybrid bipolar/FET amps, electronic switching and more. 467 pages in paperback.
SMALL SIGNAL AUDIO DESIGN
By Douglas Self – First Edition 2010 $95.00*
The latest from the Guru of audio. Explains audio concepts in easy-to-understand language with plenty of examples and reasoning. Inspiration for audio
designers, superb background for audio enthusiasts and especially where it comes to
component peculiarities and limitations. Expensive? Yes. Value for money? YES! Highly
recommended. 558 pages in paperback.
AUDIO POWER AMPLIFIER DESIGN HANDBOOK
by Douglas Self – 5th Edition 2009 $85.00*
"The Bible" on audio power amplifiers. Many revisions and
updates to the previous edition and now has an extra three
chapters covering Class XD, Power Amp Input Systems and
Input Processing and Auxiliarly Subsystems. Not cheap and not a book
for the beginner but if you want the best reference on Audio Power Amps,
you want this one! 463 pages in paperback.
DVD PLAYERS AND DRIVES
by K.F. Ibrahim. Published 2003. $71.00*
OP AMPS FOR EVERYONE
By Bruce Carter – 4th Edition 2013 $83.00*
This is the bible for anyone designing op amp circuits and you don't
have to be an engineer to get the most out of it. It is written in simple language
but gives lots of in-depth info, bridging the gap between the theoretical and the
practical. 281 pages,
PROGRAMMING 32-bit MICROCONTROLLERS
IN C By Luci di Jasio (2008) $79.00*
Subtitled Exploring the PIC32, a Microchip insider tells all on this powerful
PIC! Focuses on examples and exercises that show how to solve common,
real-world design problems quickly. Includes handy checklists. FREE CD-ROM includes
source code in C, the Microchip C30 compiler, and MPLAB SIM. 400 pages paperback.
PRACTICAL GUIDE TO SATELLITE TV
By Garry Cratt – Latest (7th) Edition 2008 $49.00
Written in Australia, for Australian conditions by one of Australia's foremost
satellite TV experts. If there is anything you wanted to know about setting up
a satellite TV system, (including what you can't do!) it's sure to be covered
in this 176-page paperback book.
NEWNES GUIDE TO TV & VIDEO TECHNOLOGY
By KF Ibrahim 4th Edition (Published 2007) $49.00
It's back! Provides a full and comprehensive coverage of video and television technology including HDTV and DVD. Starts with fundamentals so is
ideal for students but covers in-depth technologies such as Blu-ray, DLP,
Digital TV, etc so is also perfect for engineers. 600+ pages in paperback.
RF CIRCUIT DESIGN
by Chris Bowick, Second Edition, 2008. $63.00*
The classic RF circuit design book. RF circuit design is now more important
that ever in the wireless world. In most of the wireless devices that we use
there is an RF component – this book tells how to design and integrate in a
very practical fashion. 244 pages in paperback.
A guide to DVD technology and applications, with particular focus
on design issues and pitfalls, maintenance and repair. Ideal for
engineers, technicians, students of consumer electronics and
sales and installation staff. 319 pages in paperback.
See
Review
March
2010
See
Review
Feb
2004
SWITCHING POWER SUPPLIES A-Z
by Sanjaya Maniktala, Published April 2012. $83.00
Thoroughly revised! The most comprehensive study available of theoretical and practical aspects of controlling and measuring
EMI in switching power supplies.
ELECTRIC MOTORS AND DRIVES
By Austin Hughes & Bill Drury - 4th edition 2013 $59.00*
This is a very easy to read book with very little mathematics or
formulas. It covers the basics of all the main motor types, DC
permanent magnet and wound field, AC induction and steppers and
gives a very good description of how speed control circuits work with these
motors. Soft covers, 444 pages.
AC MACHINES
By Jim Lowe Published 2006 $66.00*
Applicable to Australian trades-level courses including NE10 AC Machines,
NE12 Synchronous Machines and the AC part of NE30 Electric Motor
Control and Protection. Covering polyphase induction motors, singlephase motors, synchronous machines and polyphase motor starting. 160
pages in paperback.
PRACTICAL VARIABLE SPEED DRIVES &
POWER ELECTRONICS
Se
e
by Malcolm Barnes. 1st Ed, Feb 2003. $73.00* Review
An essential reference for engineers and anyone who wishes
to design or use variable speed drives for induction motors.
286 pages in soft cover.
Feb
2003
BUILD YOUR OWN ELECTRIC MOTORCYCLE
PRACTICAL RF HANDBOOK
by Ian Hickman. 4th edition 2007 $61.00*
by Douglas Self 2nd Edition 2006 $69.00*
by Carl Vogel. Published 2009. $40.00*
A guide to RF design for engineers, technicians, students and enthusiasts.
Covers key topics in RF: analog design principles, transmission lines,
couplers, transformers, amplifiers, oscillators, modulation, transmitters and
receivers, propagation and antennas. 279 pages in paperback.
Alternative fuel expert Carl Vogel gives you a hands-on guide with
the latest technical information and easy-to-follow instructions
for building a two-wheeled electric vehicle – from a streamlined
scooter to a full-sized motorcycle. 384 pages in soft cover.
*NOTE: ALL PRICES ARE PLUS P&P – AUSTRALIA ONLY: $10.00 per order; NZ – $AU12.00 PER BOOK; REST OF WORLD $AU18.00 PER BOOK
PAYPAL (24/7)
INTERNET (24/7)
MAIL (24/7)
PHONE – (9-5, Mon-Fri)
eMAIL (24/7)
FAX (24/7)
To
ilicon Chip Use your PayPal account
www.siliconchip.
Call (02) 9939 3295 with
silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
Your order and card details to Your order to PO Box 139
Place100 S
com.au/Shop/Books silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
Collaroy NSW 2097
with order & credit card details
with order & credit card details (02) 9939 2648 with all details
Your
You can also order and pay for books by cheque/money order (Mail Only). Make cheques payable to Silicon Chip Publications.
Order:
ALL TITLES SUBJECT TO AVAILABILITY. PRICES VALID FOR MONTH OF MAGAZINE ISSUE ONLY. ALL PRICES INCLUDE GST
ALL S ILICON C HIP SUBSCRIBERS – PRINT,
OR BOTH – AUTOMATICALLY QUALIFY FOR A
REFERENCE $ave 10%ONLINE
DISCOUNT ON ALL BOOK OR PARTSHOP PURCHASES.
CHIP BOOKSHOP 10% (Does not apply to subscriptions)
SILICON
For the latest titles and information, please refer to our website books page: www.siliconchip.com.au/Shop/Books
PIC MICROCONTROLLERS: know it all
SELF ON AUDIO
Multiple authors $85.00
The best of subjects Newnes authors have written over the past few years,
combined in a one-stop maxi reference. Covers introduction to PICs and their
programming in Assembly, PICBASIC, MBASIC & C. 900+ pages.
PROGRAMMING and CUSTOMIZING THE
PICAXE By David Lincoln (2nd Ed, 2011) $65.00*
A great aid when wrestling with applications for the PICAXE
See
series of microcontrollers, at beginner, intermediate and
Review
April
advanced levels. Every electronics class, school and library should have a
copy, along with anyone who works with PICAXEs. 300 pages in paperback. 2011
PIC IN PRACTICE
by D W Smith. 2nd Edition - published 2006 $60.00*
Based on popular short courses on the PIC, for professionals, students
and teachers. Can be used at a variety of levels. An ideal introduction to the
world of microcontrollers. 255 pages in paperback.
PIC MICROCONTROLLER – your personal introductory course By John Morton 3rd edition 2005. $60.00*
A unique and practical guide to getting up and running with the PIC. It assumes no knowledge of microcontrollers – ideal introduction for students,
teachers, technicians and electronics enthusiasts. Revised 3rd edition focuses entirely
on re-programmable flash PICs such as 16F54, 16F84 12F508 and 12F675. 226 pages
in paperback.
A collection of 35 classic magazine articles offering a dependable methodology for designing audio power amplifiers to improve performance at every
point without significantly increasing cost. Includes compressors/limiters,
hybrid bipolar/FET amps, electronic switching and more. 467 pages in paperback.
SMALL SIGNAL AUDIO DESIGN
By Douglas Self – First Edition 2010 $95.00*
The latest from the Guru of audio. Explains audio concepts in easy-to-understand language with plenty of examples and reasoning. Inspiration for audio
designers, superb background for audio enthusiasts and especially where it comes to
component peculiarities and limitations. Expensive? Yes. Value for money? YES! Highly
recommended. 558 pages in paperback.
AUDIO POWER AMPLIFIER DESIGN HANDBOOK
by Douglas Self – 5th Edition 2009 $85.00*
"The Bible" on audio power amplifiers. Many revisions and
updates to the previous edition and now has an extra three
chapters covering Class XD, Power Amp Input Systems and
Input Processing and Auxiliarly Subsystems. Not cheap and not a book
for the beginner but if you want the best reference on Audio Power Amps,
you want this one! 463 pages in paperback.
DVD PLAYERS AND DRIVES
by K.F. Ibrahim. Published 2003. $71.00*
OP AMPS FOR EVERYONE
By Bruce Carter – 4th Edition 2013 $83.00*
This is the bible for anyone designing op amp circuits and you don't
have to be an engineer to get the most out of it. It is written in simple language
but gives lots of in-depth info, bridging the gap between the theoretical and the
practical. 281 pages,
PROGRAMMING 32-bit MICROCONTROLLERS
IN C By Luci di Jasio (2008) $79.00*
Subtitled Exploring the PIC32, a Microchip insider tells all on this powerful
PIC! Focuses on examples and exercises that show how to solve common,
real-world design problems quickly. Includes handy checklists. FREE CD-ROM includes
source code in C, the Microchip C30 compiler, and MPLAB SIM. 400 pages paperback.
PRACTICAL GUIDE TO SATELLITE TV
By Garry Cratt – Latest (7th) Edition 2008 $49.00
Written in Australia, for Australian conditions by one of Australia's foremost
satellite TV experts. If there is anything you wanted to know about setting up
a satellite TV system, (including what you can't do!) it's sure to be covered
in this 176-page paperback book.
NEWNES GUIDE TO TV & VIDEO TECHNOLOGY
By KF Ibrahim 4th Edition (Published 2007) $49.00
It's back! Provides a full and comprehensive coverage of video and television technology including HDTV and DVD. Starts with fundamentals so is
ideal for students but covers in-depth technologies such as Blu-ray, DLP,
Digital TV, etc so is also perfect for engineers. 600+ pages in paperback.
RF CIRCUIT DESIGN
by Chris Bowick, Second Edition, 2008. $63.00*
The classic RF circuit design book. RF circuit design is now more important
that ever in the wireless world. In most of the wireless devices that we use
there is an RF component – this book tells how to design and integrate in a
very practical fashion. 244 pages in paperback.
A guide to DVD technology and applications, with particular focus
on design issues and pitfalls, maintenance and repair. Ideal for
engineers, technicians, students of consumer electronics and
sales and installation staff. 319 pages in paperback.
See
Review
March
2010
See
Review
Feb
2004
SWITCHING POWER SUPPLIES A-Z
by Sanjaya Maniktala, Published April 2012. $83.00
Thoroughly revised! The most comprehensive study available of theoretical and practical aspects of controlling and measuring
EMI in switching power supplies.
ELECTRIC MOTORS AND DRIVES
By Austin Hughes & Bill Drury - 4th edition 2013 $59.00*
This is a very easy to read book with very little mathematics or
formulas. It covers the basics of all the main motor types, DC
permanent magnet and wound field, AC induction and steppers and
gives a very good description of how speed control circuits work with these
motors. Soft covers, 444 pages.
AC MACHINES
By Jim Lowe Published 2006 $66.00*
Applicable to Australian trades-level courses including NE10 AC Machines,
NE12 Synchronous Machines and the AC part of NE30 Electric Motor
Control and Protection. Covering polyphase induction motors, singlephase motors, synchronous machines and polyphase motor starting. 160
pages in paperback.
PRACTICAL VARIABLE SPEED DRIVES &
POWER ELECTRONICS
Se
e
by Malcolm Barnes. 1st Ed, Feb 2003. $73.00* Review
An essential reference for engineers and anyone who wishes
to design or use variable speed drives for induction motors.
286 pages in soft cover.
Feb
2003
BUILD YOUR OWN ELECTRIC MOTORCYCLE
PRACTICAL RF HANDBOOK
by Ian Hickman. 4th edition 2007 $61.00*
by Douglas Self 2nd Edition 2006 $69.00*
by Carl Vogel. Published 2009. $40.00*
A guide to RF design for engineers, technicians, students and enthusiasts.
Covers key topics in RF: analog design principles, transmission lines,
couplers, transformers, amplifiers, oscillators, modulation, transmitters and
receivers, propagation and antennas. 279 pages in paperback.
Alternative fuel expert Carl Vogel gives you a hands-on guide with
the latest technical information and easy-to-follow instructions
for building a two-wheeled electric vehicle – from a streamlined
scooter to a full-sized motorcycle. 384 pages in soft cover.
*NOTE: ALL PRICES ARE PLUS P&P – AUSTRALIA ONLY: $10.00 per order; NZ – $AU12.00 PER BOOK; REST OF WORLD $AU18.00 PER BOOK
PAYPAL (24/7)
INTERNET (24/7)
MAIL (24/7)
PHONE – (9-5, Mon-Fri)
eMAIL (24/7)
FAX (24/7)
To
siliconchip.com.au
2008 101
Use your PayPal account
www.siliconchip.
Call (02)
9939 3295 with
silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
Your order and card details to Your order to PO Box 139 March
Place
com.au/Shop/Books silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
Collaroy NSW 2097
with order & credit card details
with order & credit card details (02) 9939 2648 with all details
Your
You can also order and pay for books by cheque/money order (Mail Only). Make cheques payable to Silicon Chip Publications.
Order:
ALL TITLES SUBJECT TO AVAILABILITY. PRICES VALID FOR MONTH OF MAGAZINE ISSUE ONLY. ALL PRICES INCLUDE GST
MARKET CENTRE
Cash in your surplus gear. Advertise it here in Silicon Chip.
CLASSIFIED ADVERTISING RATES
Advertising rates for these pages: Classified ads: $29.50 (incl. GST) for up to 20
words plus 85 cents for each additional word. Display ads: $54.50 (incl. GST) per
column centimetre (max. 10cm). Closing date: 5 weeks prior to month of sale.
To book your classified ad, email the text to silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au and
include your credit card details, or fax (02) 9939 2648, or post to Silicon Chip
Classifieds, PO Box 139, Collaroy, NSW, Australia 2097.
Enclosed is my cheque/money order for $__________ or please debit my
o
Visa Card o Master Card
Card No.
Signature_____________________________ Card expiry date______/______
Name _________________________________________________________
Street _________________________________________________________
Suburb/town ______________________________ Postcode______________
Phone:______________ Fax:______________ Email:___________________
FOR SALE
MicroByte Electronics: PIC Micros
– Development Board – Development
tools & Components. Phone: (03) 9378
4288. info<at>microbyte.com.au; www.
microbyte.com.au
PCBs MADE, ONE OR MANY. Any
format, hobbyists welcome. Sesame
Electronics Phone (02) 9593 1025.
sesame<at>sesame.com.au
www.sesame.com.au
RCS RADIO/DESIGN is at 41 Arlewis
St, Chester Hill 2162, NSW Australia
and has all the published PC boards
from SC, EA, ETI, HE, AEM & others. Ph
(02) 9738 0330.
sales<at>rcsradio.com.au
www.rcsradio.com.au
12V Batteries, <6mths use. 5, 7, 9A/h,
$1 per A/h. Ongoing availability. Pickup
only, Highbury, SA.
petria<at>adam.com.au
LEDs! I NOW HAVE good stocks of
Nichia superbright oval LEDs, as well
as 5mm Agilent (HP) LEDs. These
are fantastic, bright brand-name qual-
Circuit & Design Ideas Wanted
Do you have a good circuit idea? If so, sketch it out, write a brief description of its operation & send it to us. Provided your idea is workable & original, we’ll publish it in Circuit
Notebook & you’ll make some money. We pay up to $100 for a good circuit idea or you
could win some test gear. Silicon Chip Publications, PO Box 139, Collaroy, NSW 2097.
102 Silicon Chip
ity LEDs at Chinese LED prices! Also
Osram surface mount range and other
NOS standard and superbright brand
name LEDs from just a few cents each.
Also Cree X-Lamps, 5 and 10 watt power
LEDs, LED drivers, kits and all sorts of
other stuff. www.ledsales.com.au
KIT ASSEMBLY
KEITH RIPPON KIT ASSEMBLY &
REPAIR:
* Australia & New Zealand
* Small production runs.
Phone Keith 0409 662 794.
keith.rippon<at>gmail.com
WANTED
CUSTOMERS: Truscotts Electronic
World – large range of semiconductors
siliconchip.com.au
ELNEC IC PROGRAMMERS
VIDEO - AUDIO - PC
High quality
Realistic prices
Free software updates
Large range of adaptors
Windows 95/98/Me/NT/2k/XP
distribution amps - splitters
digital standards converters - tbc's
switchers - cables - adaptors
genlockers - scan converters
bulk vga cable - wallplates
CLEVERSCOPE
USB OSCILLOSCOPES
DVS5c & DVS5s
High Performance
Video / S-Video
and Audio Splitters
2 x 100MSa/s 10bit inputs + trigger
100MHz bandwidth
8 x digital inputs
4M samples/input
Sig-gen + spectrum analyser
Windows 98/Me/NT/2k/XP
MD12 Media Distribution Amplifier
QUEST
®
IMAGECRAFT C COMPILERS
ANSI C compilers, Windows IDE
AVR, TMS430, ARM7/ARM9
68HC08, 68HC11, 68HC12
Quest AV®
HQ VGA
Cables
GRANTRONICS PTY LTD
www.grantronics.com.au
AWP1
A-V Wallplate
Come to the
specialists...
Satellite TV Reception
International satellite
TV reception in your
home is now affordable.
Send for your free info
pack containing equipment catalog, satellite
lists, etc or call for appointment to view.
We can display all satellites from 76.5°
to 180°.
AV-COMM P/L, 24/9 Powells Rd,
Brookvale, NSW 2100.
Tel: 02 9939 4377 or 9939 4378.
Fax: 9939 4376; www.avcomm.com.au
C O N T R O L S
You get results
faster with the
world’s easiest controllers!
best v
alue!
Developer’s Kit $193 includes programming cable & software
Made in Australia - enthusiastic users world-wide
splat-sc.com
and passive components for industry,
hobbyist and amateur projects including Drew Diamond. 27 The Mall, South
Croydon, Melbourne. (03) 9723 3860.
electronicworld<at>optusnet.com.au
WANTED: EARLY HIFIs, AMPLIFIERS,
siliconchip.com.au
®
®
Quest Electronics Pty Limited abn 83 003 501 282 t/a Questronix
Products, Specials & Pricelist at www.questronix.com.au
fax (02) 4341 2795
phone (02) 4343 1970
email: questav<at>questronix.com.au
Do you have wireless problems?
Telelink has wireless solutions!
If you want the right ‘wireless’ ingredients for a
successful project recipe, THINK Telelink! Don’t
want to be confused by wireless gobbledegook
and confusing buzz words? TALK to Telelink!
We will give you honest advice so that you
can make the right purchase decision for
your OEM low power wireless requirements.
Browse our website for more information about
our products. If you have any questions speak
with a Telelink Communications representative.
At Telelink we sell solutions, not problems!
01010101
MS120OEM216
$149 1-off
VGA Splitter
VGS2
Telelink Communications
www.telelink.com.au
e-mail Jack Chomley – jack<at>telelink.com.au
or call (07) 4934 0413 or 0428 199 551
Speakers, Turntables, Valves, Books,
Quad, Leak, Pye, Lowther, Ortofon,
SME, Western Electric, Altec, Marantz,
McIntosh, Tannoy, Goodmans, Wharfedale, radio and wireless. Collector/
Hobbyist will pay cash. (07) 5471 1062.
johnmurt<at>highprofile.com.au
www.dontronics.com has 300 selected
hardware and software products available from over 40 world wide manufacturers, and authors.
Olimex Development Boards & Tools:
ARM, AVR, MAXQ, MSP430 and PIC.
Atmel Programmers And Compilers:
STK500, Codevision C, Bascom AVR,
FED AVIDICY Pro, MikroElektronika Basic
and Pascal, Flash File support, and boot
loaders.
PICmicro Programmers And Compilers:
microEngineering Labs USB programmers, adapters, and Basic Compilers, DIY
(Kitsrus) USB programmers, MikroElektronika Basic, Pascal, DSpic Pascal Compilers,
CCS C, FED C, Hi-Tech C, MikroElektronika
C, disassembler and hex tools.
CAN: Lawicell CANUSB, CAN232
FTDI: USB Family of IC ‘s. FT232RL,
FT2452RL, also BL and others.
4DSystems LCD/Graphics: Add VGA
monitor, or OLED LCD to your micro. Simple Serial I/F.
Heaps And Heaps Of USB Products:
TTL, RS-232, RS-485, modules, cables,
analyzers, CRO’s.
Popular Easysync USB To RS-232
Cable: Works when the others fail. Only
one recommended by CBUS. Money back
guarantee.
www.dontronics-shop.com
March 2008 103
Do You Eat, Breathe and Sleep TECHNOLOGY?
Opportunities for full-time and part-time positions all over Australia & New Zealand
Jaycar Electronics is a rapidly growing, Australian
owned, international retailer with more than 39 stores in
Australia and New Zealand. Our aggressive expansion
programme has resulted in the need for dedicated
individuals to join our team to assist us in achieving our
goals.
We pride ourselves on the technical knowledge of our
staff. Do you think that the following statements describe
you? Please put a tick in the boxes that do:
Knowledge of electronics, particularly at component level.
Assemble projects or kits yourself for car, computer, audio, etc.
Have empathy with others who have the same interest as you.
May have worked in some retail already (not obligatory).
Have energy, enthusiasm and a personality that enjoys
helping people.
Appreciates an opportunity for future advancement.
Have an eye for detail.
SPK360
3/5/06
1:10 PM
Why not do something you love and get paid for it? Please
write or email us with your details, along with your C.V.
and any qualifications you may have. We pay a
competitive salary, sales commissions and have great
benefits like a liberal staff purchase policy.
Send to:
Retail Operations Manager - Jaycar Electronics Pty Ltd
P.O. Box 6424 Silverwater NSW 1811
Email: jobs<at>jaycar.com.au
Jaycar Electronics is an equal opportunity employer and
actively promotes staff from within the organisation.
Page 1
DOWNLOAD OUR CATALOG at
20 years experience!
www.iinet.net.au/~worcom
HI-FISPEAKER REPAIRS
WORLDWIDE ELECTRONIC COMPONENTS
PO Box 631, Hillarys, WA 6923
Ph: (08) 9307 7305 Fax: (08) 9307 7309
Email: worcom<at>iinet.net.au
Specialising in UK, US and Danish brands.
Speakerbits are your vintage, rare and collectable speaker
repair experts. Foam surrounds, voice coils, complete
recone kits and more. Original OEM parts for Scan-Speak,
Dynaudio, Tannoy, JBL, ElectroVoice and others!
SPK360
YOUR EXPERT SPEAKER REPAIR SPECIALISTS
tel: 03 9647 7000 www.speakerbits.com
RETAIL MANAGER: PERTH STORE
Altronics is a dynamic national company involved in retailing and
wholesaling a wide range of electronic equipment to the trade and
enthusiast markets.
We are searching for a motivated manager to join our Perth team. The successful applicant will
have several years experience in retail, preferably with management experience and a
background in the electronics industry.
Excellent communication and customer service skills are essential. This is a hands-on position
which involves serving customers, processing orders, merchandise control and supervision of
our retail team. A generous salary and bonus scheme will be provided.
To register your interest, forward your resume to Dean Stephens
via email at: dean.stephens<at>altronics.com.au
174 Roe St. Perth WA 6000.
Advertising Index
555 Electronics............................. 43
Alternative Technology Assoc...... 92
Altronics.........................loose insert
Alvin Electronics........................... 13
Amateur Scientist CDs............... IBC
Av-Comm................................... 103
BitScope Designs........................... 3
Computronics............................. 102
Dick Smith Electronics............ 18-21
Dontronics.................................. 103
Ecowatch.................................... 103
Emona Instruments...................... 95
Grantronics................................. 103
Harbuch Electronics..................... 92
High Profile Communications..... 103
Instant PCBs.............................. 104
Jaycar........................ IFC,49-56,104
JED Microprocessors..................... 5
Keith Rippon............................... 102
LED Sales.................................. 102
Microgram Computers.............. OBC
Microzed Computers...................... 6
Microbyte Electronics................. 102
Ocean Controls............................ 97
Ozitronics..................................... 41
Prime Electronics......................... 11
Quest Electronics....................... 103
RCS Radio................................. 102
RF Modules................................ 104
Sesame Electronics................... 102
Silicon Chip Binders......... 77,92,104
Silicon Chip Bookshop........ 100-101
SC Perf. Elect. For Cars.......... 37,80
Silicon Chip Subscriptions........... 57
Siomar.......................................... 45
Soundlabs Group......................... 79
Speakerbits................................ 104
Splat Controls............................. 103
Telelink....................................... 103
Tenrod Australia........................... 83
Truscotts Electronic World.......... 102
Trusys......................................... 102
Vaf Research.................................. 7
Wagner Electronics...................... 41
Worldwide Elect. Components... 104
PC Boards
Printed circuit boards for SILICON
CHIP designs can be obtained from
RCS Radio Pty Ltd. Phone (02) 9738
0330. Fax (02) 9738 0334.
Ph: 1300 797 007 Fax: 1300 789 777 Internet: www.altronics.com.au
104 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
STIC
FANTAIDEA
GIFT UDENTS
FOR SFT ALL
O S!
AGE
THEAMATEUR SCIENTIST
An incredible CD with over 1000 classic projects
from the pages of Scientific American,
covering every field of science...
THE LATEST
VERSION 4 –
WITH EVEN
MORE
FEATURES!
Arguably THE most IMPORTANT collection
of scientific projects ever put together!
This is version 4, Super Science Fair Edition
from the pages of Scientific American.
As well as specific project material, the CDs
contain hints and tips by experienced amateur
scientists, details on building
science apparatus, a large
database of chemicals and
so much more.
ONLY
62
$
00
PLUS $10 Pack and Post
within Australia
NZ P&P: $AU12.00,
Elsewhere: $AU18.00
“A must for every science student,
science teacher, science lab . . . or simply
for those with an enquiring mind . . .”
Just a tiny selection of the incredible range of projects:
! Build a seismograph to study earthquakes ! Make soap bubbles that last for
months ! Monitor the health of local streams ! Preserve biological specimens !
Build a carbon dioxide laser ! Grow bacteria cultures safely at home ! Build a
ripple tank to study wave phenomena ! Discover how plants grow in low gravity !
Do strange experiments with sound ! Use a hot wire to study the crystal structure
of steel ! Extract and purify DNA in your kitchen !Create a laser hologram ! Study
variable stars like a pro ! Investigate vortexes in water ! Cultivate slime moulds !
Study the flight efficiency of soaring birds ! How to make an Electret ! Construct
fluid lenses ! Raise butterflies as experimental animals ! Study the physics of
spinning tops ! Build an apparatus for studying chaotic systems ! Detect metals in
air, liquids, or solids ! Photograph an ant's brain and nervous system ! Use
magnets to make fluids into solids ! Measure the metabolism of an insect . . . !
and many, many more (a thousand more, in fact!)
See the V2 review in SILICON CHIP, October 2004. . . or read on line at siliconchip.com.au
This is the ALL-NEW Version 4 . . . it’s even BETTER!
HERE’S HOW TO ORDER YOUR COPY:
BY PHONE:*
(02) 9939 3295
9-5 Mon-Fri
BY FAX:#
<at>
(02) 9939 2648
24 Hours 7 Days
BY EMAIL:#
silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
24 Hours 7 Days
BY MAIL:#
BY PAYPAL:#
PO Box 139,
Collaroy NSW 2097
silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
24 Hours 7 Days
* Please have your credit card handy! # Don’t forget to include your name, address, phone no and credit card details.
BY INTERNET:^
siliconchip.com.au
24 Hours 7 Days
^ You will be prompted for required information
There’s also a handy order form inside this issue.
Exclusive in SILICON
Australia to: CHIP siliconchip.com.au
siliconchip.com.au
March 2008 105
|